| United States Patent Application |
20190388609
|
| Kind Code
|
A1
|
|
Lanigan; Richard J.
;   et al.
|
December 26, 2019
|
Apparatus, System and Method for Fluid Delivery
Abstract
A fill adapter system for an infusion pump assembly. The system includes
a reusable fill adapter base, the base including a volume control
mechanism to adjust an available fill volume of a reservoir of the
infusion pump assembly and a pump mechanism configured to pump air into a
fluid vial. The system also includes a vial adapter assembly including a
first needle configured to penetrate a septum of the fluid vial for
fluidly coupling the pump mechanism to the fluid vial and a second needle
having a first end configured to penetrate the septum of the fluid vial
and a second end configured to penetrate a septum of the reservoir of the
infusion pump assembly to allow transfer of fluid from the fluid vial to
the reservoir of the infusion pump assembly in response to air being
pumped into the fluid vial and a needle carriage adapted to carry the
first needle and the second needle, wherein the needle carriage slidably
attached to the interior of the vial adapter assembly, wherein the needle
carriage adapted to slide from a vial end of the vial adapter to a
receptacle end of the vial adapter.
| Inventors: |
Lanigan; Richard J.; (Concord, NH)
; Foo; Bright C.K.; (Hollis, NH)
; Kamen; Dean; (Bedford, NH)
|
| Applicant: | | Name | City | State | Country | Type | DEKA Products Limited Partnership | Manchester | NH | US | | |
| Family ID:
|
43805733
|
| Appl. No.:
|
16/259615
|
| Filed:
|
January 28, 2019 |
Related U.S. Patent Documents
| | | | |
|
| Application Number | Filing Date | Patent Number | |
|---|
| | 12649681 | Dec 30, 2009 | 10188787 | |
| | 16259615 | | | |
| | 12347985 | Dec 31, 2008 | 8491570 | |
| | 12649681 | | | |
| | 12347982 | Dec 31, 2008 | 9526830 | |
| | 12649681 | | | |
| | 12347984 | Dec 31, 2008 | 8414563 | |
| | 12649681 | | | |
| | 61142042 | Dec 31, 2008 | | |
| | 61225794 | Jul 15, 2009 | | |
| | 61018054 | Dec 31, 2007 | | |
| | 61018042 | Dec 31, 2007 | | |
| | 61017989 | Dec 31, 2007 | | |
| | 61018002 | Dec 31, 2007 | | |
| | 61018339 | Dec 31, 2007 | | |
| | 61023645 | Jan 25, 2008 | | |
| | 61101053 | Sep 29, 2008 | | |
| | 61101077 | Sep 29, 2008 | | |
| | 61101105 | Sep 29, 2008 | | |
| | 61101115 | Sep 29, 2008 | | |
| | 61018054 | Dec 31, 2007 | | |
| | 61018042 | Dec 31, 2007 | | |
| | 61017989 | Dec 31, 2007 | | |
| | 61018002 | Dec 31, 2007 | | |
| | 61018339 | Dec 31, 2007 | | |
| | 61023645 | Jan 25, 2008 | | |
| | 61101053 | Sep 29, 2008 | | |
| | 61101077 | Sep 29, 2008 | | |
| | 61101105 | Sep 29, 2008 | | |
| | 61101115 | Sep 29, 2008 | | |
| | 61018054 | Dec 31, 2007 | | |
| | 61018042 | Dec 31, 2007 | | |
| | 61017989 | Dec 31, 2007 | | |
| | 61018002 | Dec 31, 2007 | | |
| | 61018339 | Dec 31, 2007 | | |
| | 61023645 | Jan 25, 2008 | | |
| | 61101053 | Sep 29, 2008 | | |
| | 61101077 | Sep 29, 2008 | | |
| | 61101105 | Sep 29, 2008 | | |
| | 61101115 | Sep 29, 2008 | | |
|
|
| Current U.S. Class: |
1/1 |
| Current CPC Class: |
A61M 2205/3569 20130101; A61M 2205/18 20130101; A61J 1/20 20130101; A61M 2205/3546 20130101; A61M 2205/8237 20130101; A61M 2005/14268 20130101; A61M 5/1413 20130101; A61M 2205/70 20130101; A61M 2209/086 20130101; A61M 2205/0266 20130101; G05D 7/0647 20130101; A61M 5/16886 20130101; A61M 2205/7536 20130101; A61M 2205/3331 20130101; A61M 5/142 20130101; A61M 5/14248 20130101; A61M 2205/59 20130101; A61M 2205/3576 20130101; A61M 5/16809 20130101; A61M 2205/50 20130101; A61M 2205/3393 20130101; A61M 2205/6018 20130101; A61M 2205/3375 20130101; H01Q 1/273 20130101; G05D 7/0676 20130101; A61M 2205/3515 20130101; G01F 11/086 20130101; H01Q 9/265 20130101; A61M 2209/045 20130101; A61M 5/14244 20130101 |
| International Class: |
A61M 5/14 20060101 A61M005/14; A61J 1/20 20060101 A61J001/20; A61M 5/142 20060101 A61M005/142; A61M 5/168 20060101 A61M005/168; G01F 11/08 20060101 G01F011/08; G05D 7/06 20060101 G05D007/06; H01Q 1/27 20060101 H01Q001/27; H01Q 9/26 20060101 H01Q009/26 |
Claims
1. A fill adapter system for an infusion pump assembly comprising: a
reusable fill adapter base configured to releasably engage a reservoir
assembly of the infusion pump assembly; and a vial adapter assembly
comprising: at least two vial fingers having a spring force attached to
the interior of the housing and a bent portion and configured to maintain
the position of the fluid vial wherein the fluid vial overcomes the
spring force, wherein when the vial adapter is attached to the fluid
vial, the bent portion and the top portion of the fluid vial are not in
contact and a predetermined length of separation distance is maintained
between the bent portion and a top portion of the fluid vial comprising a
fluid vial septum; wherein when the fluid vial is removed from the vial
adapter, the fluid vial first moves the predetermined length of
separation distance and the bent portion catches the top portion of the
fluid vial, and wherein a tip of a needle is removed from the fluid in
the fluid vial and is located inside the fluid vial septum, whereby the
fluid in the fluid vial will not continue to flow when the vial adapter
is being removed from the fluid vial.
2. The fill adapter of claim 1, wherein the base comprising a volume
control mechanism comprising a turn dial to adjust an available fill
volume of a reservoir of the infusion pump assembly.
3. The fill adapter of claim 1, wherein the base further comprising a
pump mechanism configured to pump air into a fluid vial.
4. The fill adapter of claim 1, further comprising a first needle
configured to penetrate the fluid vial septum for fluidly coupling the
pump mechanism to the fluid vial.
5. The fill adapter of claim 4, wherein the vial adapter assembly further
comprising a hydrophobic filter within a fluid path of the first needle.
6. The fill adapter of claim 1 wherein the volume control mechanism
further comprising a push plate, wherein the turn dial actuates the push
plate and wherein the push plate adjusts the available fill volume of a
reservoir of the infusion pump assembly.
7. The fill adapter of claim 1 further comprising a weight scale, the
weight scale determining the weight of the infusion pump assembly before
filling a volume of fluid and the weight scale determining the weight of
the infusion pump assembly after the reservoir is filled to a volume.
8. The fill adapter of claim 4, further comprising a second needle having
a first end configured to penetrate the fluid vial septum and a second
end configured to penetrate a reservoir septum of the infusion pump
assembly to allow transfer of fluid from the fluid vial to the reservoir
of the infusion pump assembly in response to air being pumped into the
fluid vial; and
9. The fill adapter of claim 8, further comprising a needle carriage
adapted to carry the first needle and the second needle, wherein the
needle carriage slidably attached to the interior of the vial adapter
assembly, wherein the needle carriage adapted to slide from a vial end of
the vial adapter to a receptacle end of the vial adapter.
10. A filling system for an infusion pump assembly comprising: a reusable
fill adapter base configured to releasably engage a reservoir assembly of
the infusion pump assembly, the base comprising: a first needle, the
first needle configured to penetrate a fluid vial septum for fluidly
coupling the pump mechanism to the fluid vial; at least two vial fingers
having a spring force attached to the interior of the housing and a bent
portion and configured to maintain the position of the fluid vial wherein
the fluid vial overcomes the spring force, wherein when the vial adapter
is attached to the fluid vial, the bent portion and the top portion of
the fluid vial are not in contact and a predetermined length of
separation distance is maintained between the bent portion and the fluid
vial septum; and a second needle having a first end configured to
penetrate the fluid vial septum and a second end configured to penetrate
a reservoir septum of the infusion pump assembly to allow transfer of
fluid from the fluid vial to the reservoir of the infusion pump assembly
in response to air being pumped into the fluid vial, wherein when the
fluid vial is removed from the vial adapter, the fluid vial first moves
the predetermined length of separation distance and the bent portion
catches the top portion of the fluid vial, and wherein a tip of a needle
is removed from the fluid in the fluid vial and is located inside the
fluid vial septum, whereby the fluid in the fluid vial will not continue
to flow when the vial adapter is being removed from the fluid vial.
11. The filling system of claim 10, wherein the reusable fill adapter
base comprising a volume control mechanism comprising a turn dial
configured to adjust an available fill volume of a reservoir of the
infusion pump assembly.
12. The filling system of claim 10, wherein the reusable fill adapter
base comprising a pump mechanism configured to pump air into a fluid
vial.
13. The filling system of claim 11, wherein the volume control mechanism
further comprising a push plate, wherein the turn dial actuates the push
plate and wherein the push plate adjusts the available fill volume of a
reservoir of the infusion pump assembly
14. The filling system of claim 10, further comprising a weight scale,
the weight scale determining the weight of the infusion pump assembly
before filling a volume of fluid and the weight scale determining the
weight of the infusion pump assembly after the reservoir is filled to a
volume.
15. A vial adapter comprising: a housing having a vial end configured to
receive a vial and a receptacle end configured to attach to a fill
adapter base and interior wall features; and at least two vial fingers
having a spring force attached to the interior of the housing and a bent
portion and configured to maintain the position of the fluid vial wherein
the fluid vial overcomes the spring force, wherein when the vial adapter
is attached to the fluid vial, the bent portion and the top portion of
the fluid vial are not in contact and a predetermined length of
separation distance is maintained between the bent portion and a fluid
vial septum, wherein when the fluid vial is removed from the vial
adapter, the fluid vial first moves the predetermined length of
separation distance and the bent portion catches the top portion of the
fluid vial, and wherein a tip of a needle is removed from the fluid in
the fluid vial and is located inside the fluid vial septum, whereby the
fluid in the fluid vial will not continue to flow when the vial adapter
is being removed from the fluid vial.
16. The vial adapter of claim 15, further comprising a needle carriage
slidably attached to the interior of the housing.
17. The vial adapter of claim 15, further comprising a disc slidably
attached to the interior of the housing, the disc having a first position
on the receptacle end of the housing and a second position on the vial
end of the housing and configured to matably attach to a needle carriage,
wherein the needle carriage matably attaches to the disc and the needle
carriage and disc slide to the vial end of the housing and wherein the
disc is locked into a position on the vial end by interior wall features
of the housing.
18. The vial adapter of claim 15, further comprising at least one locking
feature, the locking feature adapted to mate with at least one key
feature on a fill adapter base.
Description
CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
[0001] The present application Continuation of U.S. patent application
Ser. No. 12/649,681, filed Dec. 30, 2009, now U.S. Pat. No. 10,188,787,
issued Jan. 29, 2019 and entitled Apparatus, System and Method for Fluid
Delivery (Attorney Docket No. G85) which is a Non-Provisional Patent
Application, and which is hereby incorporated herein by reference in its
entirety, which claims priority from the following U.S. Provisional
Patent Applications, each of which is hereby incorporated herein by
reference in its entirety:
[0002] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/142,042, filed Dec.
31, 2008 and entitled Method, System and Apparatus for Verification of
Volume and Pumping (Attorney Docket No. G78); and U.S. Provisional Patent
Application Ser. No. 61/225,794, filed Jul. 15, 2009 and entitled
Infusion Pump Assembly (Attorney Docket No. H48).
[0003] U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/649,681 is also a
Continuation-in-Part of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/347,985,
filed Dec. 31, 2008, now U.S. Pat. No. 8,491,570, issued Jul. 23, 2013
and entitled Infusion Pump Assembly (Attorney Docket No. G75), which is
hereby incorporated herein by reference in its entirety, which
application also claims priority from the following U.S. Provisional
Patent Applications, all of which are hereby incorporated herein by
reference in their entireties:
[0004] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/018,054, filed Dec.
31, 2007 and entitled Patch Pump with Shape Memory Wire Pump Actuator
(Attorney Docket No. E87);
[0005] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/018,042, filed Dec.
31, 2007 and entitled Patch Pump with External Infusion Set (Attorney
Docket No. E88);
[0006] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/017,989, filed Dec.
31, 2007 and entitled Wearable Infusion Pump with Disposable Base
(Attorney Docket No. E89);
[0007] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/018,002, filed Dec.
31, 2007 and entitled Patch Pump with Rotational Engagement Assembly
(Attorney Docket No. E90);
[0008] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/018,339, filed Dec.
31, 2007 and entitled System and Method for Controlling a Shape-Memory
Actuator (Attorney Docket No. E91);
[0009] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/023,645, filed Jan.
25, 2008 and entitled Infusion Pump with Bolus Button (Attorney Docket
No. F49);
[0010] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/101,053, filed Sep.
29, 2008 and entitled Infusion Pump Assembly with a Switch Assembly
(Attorney Docket No. F73);
[0011] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/101,077, filed Sep.
29, 2008 and entitled Infusion Pump Assembly with a Tubing Storage
(Attorney Docket No. F74);
[0012] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/101,105, filed Sep.
29, 2008 and entitled Improved Infusion Pump Assembly (Attorney Docket
No. F75); and
[0013] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/101,115, filed Sep.
29, 2008 and entitled Filling Apparatus and Methods for an Infusion Pump
Assembly (Attorney Docket No. G08).
[0014] U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/649,681 is also a
Continuation-in-Part of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/347,982,
filed Dec. 31, 2008, now U.S. Pat. No. 9,526,830, issued Dec. 27, 2016
and entitled Wearable Pump Assembly (Attorney Docket No. G76), which is
hereby incorporated herein by reference in its entirety, which
application also claims priority from the following U.S. Provisional
Patent Applications, all of which are hereby incorporated herein by
reference in their entireties:
[0015] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/018,054, filed Dec.
31, 2007 and entitled Patch Pump with Shape Memory Wire Pump Actuator
(Attorney Docket No. E87);
[0016] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/018,042, filed Dec.
31, 2007 and entitled Patch Pump with External Infusion Set (Attorney
Docket No. E88);
[0017] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/017,989, filed Dec.
31, 2007 and entitled Wearable Infusion Pump with Disposable Base
(Attorney Docket No. E89);
[0018] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/018,002, filed Dec.
31, 2007 and entitled Patch Pump with Rotational Engagement Assembly
(Attorney Docket No. E90);
[0019] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/018,339, filed Dec.
31, 2007 and entitled System and Method for Controlling a Shape-Memory
Actuator (Attorney Docket No. E91);
[0020] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/023,645, filed Jan.
25, 2008 and entitled Infusion Pump with Bolus Button (Attorney Docket
No. F49);
[0021] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/101,053, filed Sep.
29, 2008 and entitled Infusion Pump Assembly with a Switch Assembly
(Attorney Docket No. F73);
[0022] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/101,077, filed Sep.
29, 2008 and entitled Infusion Pump Assembly with a Tubing Storage
(Attorney Docket No. F74); U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No.
61/101,105, filed Sep. 29, 2008 and entitled Improved Infusion Pump
Assembly (Attorney Docket No. F75); and
[0023] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/101,115, filed Sep.
29, 2008 and entitled Filling Apparatus and Methods for an Infusion Pump
Assembly (Attorney Docket No. G08).
[0024] U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/649,681 is also a
Continuation-in-Part of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/347,984,
filed Dec. 31, 2008, now U.S. Pat. No. 8,414,563, issued Apr. 9, 2013 and
entitled Pump Assembly With Switch (Attorney Docket No. G79), which is
hereby incorporated herein by reference in its entirety, which
application also claims priority from the following U.S. Provisional
Patent Applications, all of which are hereby incorporated herein by
reference in their entireties:
[0025] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/018,054, filed Dec.
31, 2007 and entitled Patch Pump with Shape Memory Wire Pump Actuator
(Attorney Docket No. E87);
[0026] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/018,042, filed Dec.
31, 2007 and entitled Patch Pump with External Infusion Set (Attorney
Docket No. E88);
[0027] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/017,989, filed Dec.
31, 2007 and entitled Wearable Infusion Pump with Disposable Base
(Attorney Docket No. E89);
[0028] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/018,002, filed Dec.
31, 2007 and entitled Patch Pump with Rotational Engagement Assembly
(Attorney Docket No. E90);
[0029] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/018,339, filed Dec.
31, 2007 and entitled System and Method for Controlling a Shape-Memory
Actuator (Attorney Docket No. E91);
[0030] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/023,645, filed Jan.
25, 2008 and entitled Infusion Pump with Bolus Button (Attorney Docket
No. F49);
[0031] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/101,053, filed Sep.
29, 2008 and entitled Infusion Pump Assembly with a Switch Assembly
(Attorney Docket No. F73);
[0032] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/101,077, filed Sep.
29, 2008 and entitled Infusion Pump Assembly with a Tubing Storage
(Attorney Docket No. F74);
[0033] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/101,105, filed Sep.
29, 2008 and entitled Improved Infusion Pump Assembly (Attorney Docket
No. F75); and
[0034] U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/101,115, filed Sep.
29, 2008 and entitled Filling Apparatus and Methods for an Infusion Pump
Assembly (Attorney Docket No. G08).
FIELD OF THE INVENTION
[0035] This application relates generally to fluid delivery systems, and
more particularly to apparatus, system and method for fluid delivery.
BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
[0036] Many potentially valuable medicines or compounds, including
biologicals, are not orally active due to poor absorption, hepatic
metabolism or other pharmacokinetic factors. Additionally, some
therapeutic compounds, although they can be orally absorbed, are
sometimes required to be administered so often it is difficult for a
patient to maintain the desired schedule. In these cases, parenteral
delivery is often employed or could be employed. Effective parenteral
routes of drug delivery, as well as other fluids and compounds, such as
subcutaneous injection, intramuscular injection, and intravenous (IV)
administration include puncture of the skin with a needle or stylet.
Insulin is an example of a therapeutic fluid that is self-injected by
millions of diabetic patients. Users of parenterally delivered drugs may
benefit from a wearable device that would automatically deliver needed
drugs/compounds over a period of time.
[0037] To this end, there have been efforts to design portable and
wearable devices for the controlled release of therapeutics. Such devices
are known to have a reservoir such as a cartridge, syringe, or bag, and
to be electronically controlled. These devices suffer from a number of
drawbacks including the malfunction rate. Reducing the size, weight and
cost of these devices is also an ongoing challenge. Additionally, these
devices often apply to the skin and pose the challenge of frequent
re-location for application.
SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
[0038] In accordance with one aspect of the present invention a fill
adapter system for an infusion pump assembly is disclosed. The system
includes a reusable fill adapter base, the base including a volume
control mechanism to adjust an available fill volume of a reservoir of
the infusion pump assembly and a pump mechanism configured to pump air
into a fluid vial. The system also includes a vial adapter assembly
including a first needle configured to penetrate a septum of the fluid
vial for fluidly coupling the pump mechanism to the fluid vial and a
second needle having a first end configured to penetrate the septum of
the fluid vial and a second end configured to penetrate a septum of the
reservoir of the infusion pump assembly to allow transfer of fluid from
the fluid vial to the reservoir of the infusion pump assembly in response
to air being pumped into the fluid vial and a needle carriage adapted to
carry the first needle and the second needle, wherein the needle carriage
slidably attached to the interior of the vial adapter assembly, wherein
the needle carriage adapted to slide from a vial end of the vial adapter
to a receptacle end of the vial adapter.
[0039] Some embodiments of this aspect of the invention include one or
more of the following. Wherein the vial adapter assembly further includes
a hydrophobic filter within a fluid path of the first needle. Wherein the
volume control mechanism further includes a turn dial and a push plate,
wherein the turn dial actuates the push plate and wherein the push plate
adjusts the available fill volume of a reservoir of the infusion pump
assembly. Wherein the filling system further includes a weight scale, the
weight scale determining the weight of the infusion pump assembly before
filling a volume a fluid and the weight scale determining the weight of
the infusion pump assembly after the reservoir is filled to a volume.
[0040] In accordance with one aspect of the present invention a filling
system for an infusion pump assembly is disclosed. The system includes a
volume control mechanism configured to adjust an available fill volume of
a reservoir of the infusion pump assembly, a pump mechanism configured to
pump air into a fluid vial via a first needle, the first needle
configured to penetrate a septum of the fluid vial for fluidly coupling
the pump mechanism to the fluid vial, and a second needle having a first
end configured to penetrate the septum of the fluid vial and a second end
configured to penetrate a septum of the reservoir of the infusion pump
assembly to allow transfer of fluid from the fluid vial to the reservoir
of the infusion pump assembly in response to air being pumped into the
fluid vial.
[0041] Some embodiments of this aspect of the invention include one or
more of the following. Wherein the volume control mechanism further
includes a turn dial and a push plate, wherein the turn dial actuates the
push plate and wherein the push plate adjusts the available fill volume
of a reservoir of the infusion pump assembly
[0042] In accordance with one aspect of the present invention a vial
adapter. The vial adapter includes a housing having a vial end and a
receptacle end and interior wall features, a needle carriage slidably
attached to the interior of the housing, and a disc slidably attached to
the interior of the housing, the disc having a first position on the
receptacle end of the housing and a second position on the vial end of
the housing and configured to matably attach to the needle carriage,
wherein the needle carriage matably attaches to the disc and the needle
carriage and disc slide to the vial end of the housing and wherein the
disc is locked into a position on the vial end by interior wall features
of the housing.
[0043] Some embodiments of this aspect of the invention include one or
more of the following. Wherein the vial adapter further includes at least
one locking feature, the locking feature adapted to mate with at least
one key feature on a fill adapter base.
[0044] The details of one or more embodiments are set forth in the
accompanying drawings and the description below. Other features and
advantages will become apparent from the description, the drawings, and
the claims.
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
[0045] FIG. 1 is a side view of an infusion pump assembly;
[0046] FIG. 2 is a perspective view of the infusion pump assembly of FIG.
1;
[0047] FIG. 3 is an exploded view of various components of the infusion
pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0048] FIG. 4 is a cross-sectional view of the disposable housing assembly
of the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0049] FIGS. 5A-5C are cross-sectional views of an embodiment of a septum
access assembly;
[0050] FIGS. 6A-6B are cross-sectional views of another embodiment of a
septum access assembly;
[0051] FIGS. 7A-7B are partial top views of another embodiment of a septum
access assembly;
[0052] FIGS. 8A-8B are cross-sectional views of another embodiment of a
septum access assembly;
[0053] FIG. 9 is a perspective view of the infusion pump assembly of FIG.
1 showing an external infusion set;
[0054] FIGS. 10A-10E depict a plurality of hook-and-loop fastener
configurations;
[0055] FIG. 11A is an isometric view of a remote control assembly and an
alternative embodiment of the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0056] FIGS. 11B-11R depicts various views of high level schematics and
flow charts of the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0057] FIGS. 12A-12F is a plurality of display screens rendered by the
remote control assembly of FIG. 11A;
[0058] FIG. 13 is an isometric view of an alternative embodiment of the
infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0059] FIG. 14 is an isometric view of the infusion pump assembly of FIG.
13;
[0060] FIG. 15 is an isometric view of the infusion pump assembly of FIG.
13;
[0061] FIG. 16 is an isometric view of an alternative embodiment of the
infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0062] FIG. 17 is an plan view of the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 16;
[0063] FIG. 18 is a plan view of the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 16;
[0064] FIG. 19A is an exploded view of various components of the infusion
pump assembly of FIG. 16;
[0065] FIG. 19B is an isometric view of a portion of the infusion pump
assembly of FIG. 16;
[0066] FIG. 20 is a cross-sectional view of the disposable housing
assembly of the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 16;
[0067] FIG. 21 is a diagrammatic view of a fluid path within the infusion
pump assembly of FIG. 16;
[0068] FIGS. 22A-22C are diagrammatic views of a fluid path within the
infusion pump assembly of FIG. 16;
[0069] FIG. 23 is an exploded view of various components of the infusion
pump assembly of FIG. 16;
[0070] FIG. 24 is a cutaway isometric view of a pump assembly of the
infusion pump assembly of FIG. 16;
[0071] FIGS. 25A-25D are other isometric views of the pump assembly of
FIG. 24;
[0072] FIG. 26A-26B are isometric views of a measurement valve assembly of
the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 16;
[0073] FIG. 27A-27B are side views of the measurement valve assembly of
FIGS. 26A-26B;
[0074] FIGS. 28A-28D are views of a measurement valve assembly of the
infusion pump assembly of FIG. 16;
[0075] FIG. 29 is an isometric view of an alternative embodiment of the
infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0076] FIG. 30 is an isometric view of an alternative embodiment of the
infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0077] FIG. 31 is another view of the alternative embodiment infusion pump
assembly of FIG. 9;
[0078] FIG. 32 is an exploded view of another embodiment of an infusion
pump assembly;
[0079] FIG. 33 is another exploded view of the infusion pump assembly of
FIG. 32;
[0080] FIGS. 34A-34B depict another embodiment of an infusion pump
assembly;
[0081] FIGS. 35A-35C are a top view, side view, and bottom view of a
reusable housing assembly of the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 32;
[0082] FIG. 36 is an exploded view of the reusable housing assembly of
FIGS. 35A-35C;
[0083] FIG. 37 is an exploded view of the reusable housing assembly of
FIGS. 35A-35C;
[0084] FIG. 38A is an exploded view of the reusable housing assembly of
FIGS. 35A-35C;
[0085] FIG. 38B-38D are top, side and bottom views of one embodiment of a
dust cover;
[0086] FIGS. 39A-39C are a top view, side view, and bottom view of an
electrical control assembly of the reusable housing assembly of FIGS.
35A-35C;
[0087] FIGS. 40A-40C are a top view, side view, and bottom view of a base
plate of the reusable housing assembly of FIGS. 35A-35C;
[0088] FIGS. 41A-41B are a perspective top view and a perspective bottom
view of the base plate of FIGS. 40A-40C;
[0089] FIGS. 42A-42C are a top view, side view, and bottom view of a base
plate of the reusable housing assembly of FIGS. 35A-35C;
[0090] FIGS. 43A-43B depict a mechanical control assembly of the reusable
housing assembly of FIGS. 35A-35C;
[0091] FIGS. 44A-44C depict the mechanical control assembly of the
reusable housing assembly of FIGS. 35A-35C;
[0092] FIGS. 45A-45B depict the pump plunger and reservoir valve of the
mechanical control assembly of the reusable housing assembly of FIGS.
35A-35C;
[0093] FIGS. 46A-46E depict various views of the plunger pump and
reservoir valve of the mechanical control assembly of the reusable
housing assembly of FIGS. 35A-35C;
[0094] FIGS. 47A-47B depict the measurement valve of the mechanical
control assembly of the reusable housing assembly of FIGS. 35A-35C;
[0095] FIG. 48 is an exploded view of the disposable housing assembly of
the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 32;
[0096] FIG. 49A is a plan view of the disposable housing assembly of FIG.
48;
[0097] FIG. 49B is a sectional view of the disposable housing assembly of
FIG. 49A taken along line B-B;
[0098] FIG. 49C is a sectional view of the disposable housing assembly of
FIG. 49A taken along line C-C;
[0099] FIGS. 50A-50C depict the base portion of the disposable housing
assembly of FIG. 48;
[0100] FIGS. 51A-51C depict the fluid pathway cover of the disposable
housing assembly of FIG. 48;
[0101] FIGS. 52A-52C depict the membrane assembly of the disposable
housing assembly of FIG. 48;
[0102] FIGS. 53A-53C depict the top portion of the disposable housing
assembly of FIG. 48;
[0103] FIGS. 54A-54C depict the valve membrane insert of the disposable
housing assembly of FIG. 48;
[0104] FIGS. 55A-55B depict the locking ring assembly of the infusion pump
assembly of FIG. 32;
[0105] FIG. 56A-56C depict the locking ring assembly of the infusion pump
assembly of FIG. 32;
[0106] FIGS. 57-58 is an isometric view of an infusion pump assembly and a
fill adapter;
[0107] FIGS. 59-64 are various views of the fill adapter of FIG. 57;
[0108] FIG. 65 is an isometric view of another embodiment of a fill
adapter;
[0109] FIGS. 66-67 depict an infusion pump assembly and another embodiment
of a fill adapter;
[0110] FIGS. 68-74 are various views of the fill adapter of FIG. 66;
[0111] FIGS. 75-80 depict various views of an embodiment of a battery
charger;
[0112] FIGS. 81-89B depict various embodiments of battery chargers/docking
stations;
[0113] FIGS. 90A-90C are various views of a volume sensor assembly
included within the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0114] FIGS. 91A-91I are various views of a volume sensor assembly
included within the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0115] FIGS. 92A-92I are various views of a volume sensor assembly
included within the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0116] FIGS. 93A-93I are various views of a volume sensor assembly
included within the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0117] FIGS. 94A-94F are various views of a volume sensor assembly
included within the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0118] FIG. 95 is an exploded view of a volume sensor assembly included
within the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0119] FIG. 96 is a diagrammatic view of a volume sensor assembly included
within the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0120] FIG. 97 is a two-dimensional graph of a performance characteristic
of the volume sensor assembly of FIG. 96;
[0121] FIG. 98 is a two-dimensional graph of a performance characteristic
of the volume sensor assembly of FIG. 96;
[0122] FIG. 99 is a two-dimensional graph of a performance characteristic
of the volume sensor assembly of FIG. 96;
[0123] FIG. 100 is a diagrammatic view of a volume sensor assembly
included within the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0124] FIG. 101 is a two-dimensional graph of a performance characteristic
of the volume sensor assembly of FIG. 100;
[0125] FIG. 102 is a two-dimensional graph of a performance characteristic
of the volume sensor assembly of FIG. 100;
[0126] FIG. 103 is a diagrammatic view of a volume sensor assembly
included within the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0127] FIG. 104 is a two-dimensional graph of a performance characteristic
of a volume sensor assembly included within the infusion pump assembly of
FIG. 1;
[0128] FIG. 105 is a two-dimensional graph of a performance characteristic
of a volume sensor assembly included within the infusion pump assembly of
FIG. 1;
[0129] FIG. 106 is a two-dimensional graph of a performance characteristic
of a volume sensor assembly included within the infusion pump assembly of
FIG. 1;
[0130] FIG. 107 is a two-dimensional graph of a performance characteristic
of a volume sensor assembly included within the infusion pump assembly of
FIG. 1;
[0131] FIG. 108 is a two-dimensional graph of a performance characteristic
of a volume sensor assembly included within the infusion pump assembly of
FIG. 1;
[0132] FIG. 109 is a diagrammatic view of a control model for a volume
sensor assembly included within the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0133] FIG. 110 is a diagrammatic view of an electrical control assembly
for the volume sensor assembly included within the infusion pump assembly
of FIG. 1;
[0134] FIG. 111 is a diagrammatic view of a volume controller for the
volume sensor assembly included within the infusion pump assembly of FIG.
1;
[0135] FIG. 112 is a diagrammatic view of a feed forward controller of the
volume controller of FIG. 111;
[0136] FIGS. 113-114 diagrammatically depicts an implementation of an SMA
controller of the volume controller of FIG. 111;
[0137] FIG. 114A-114B is an alternate implementation of an SMA controller;
[0138] FIG. 115 diagrammatically depicts a multi-processor control
configuration that may be included within the infusion pump assembly of
FIG. 1;
[0139] FIG. 116 is a diagrammatic view of a multi-processor control
configuration that may be included within the infusion pump assembly of
FIG. 1;
[0140] FIG. 117A-117B diagrammatically depicts multi-processor
functionality;
[0141] FIG. 118 diagrammatically depicts multi-processor functionality;
[0142] FIG. 119 diagrammatically depicts multi-processor functionality;
[0143] FIGS. 120A-120E graphically depicts various software layers;
[0144] 120B-120C depict various state diagrams;
[0145] 120D graphically depicts device interaction;
[0146] 120E graphically depicts device interaction;
[0147] FIG. 121 diagrammatically depicts a volume sensor assembly included
within the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0148] FIG. 122 diagrammatically depicts an inter-connection of the
various systems of the infusion pump assembly of FIG. 1;
[0149] FIG. 123 diagrammatically depicts basal-bolus infusion events;
[0150] FIG. 124 diagrammatically depicts basal-bolus infusion events;
[0151] FIG. 125A-125G depict a hierarchial state machine;
[0152] FIG. 126A-126M depicts a hierarchial state machine;
[0153] FIG. 127 is an exemplary diagram of a split ring resonator antenna;
[0154] FIG. 128 is an exemplary diagram of a medical device configured to
utilize a split ring resonator antenna;
[0155] FIG. 129 is an exemplary diagram of a split ring resonator antenna
and transmission line from a medical infusion device;
[0156] FIG. 130 is a graph of the return loss of a split ring resonator
antenna prior to contact with human skin;
[0157] FIG. 130A is a graph of the return loss of a split ring resonator
antenna during contact with human skin;
[0158] FIG. 131 is an exemplary diagram of a split ring resonator antenna
integrated into a device which operates within close proximity to
dielectric material;
[0159] FIG. 132 is a diagram of the dimensions of the inner and outer
portion of the exemplary embodiment;
[0160] FIG. 133 is a graph of the return loss of a non-split ring
resonator antenna prior to contact with human skin;
[0161] FIG. 133A is a graph of the return loss of a non-split ring
resonator antenna during contact with human skin;
[0162] FIGS. 134-145 depict an embodiment of a charger, including various
perspective views, exploded views, and partially exploded views;
[0163] FIGS. 146A-148R are schematics of an exemplary electrical system
that may be utilized in connection with the charger of FIGS. 134-145;
[0164] FIGS. 149A-173G show various additional embodiments of a charger,
as well as various features of such additional embodiments;
[0165] FIGS. 174-193 depict various views and aspects of an embodiment of
a fill adapter;
[0166] FIGS. 194-198 depict various views and aspects of another
embodiment of a fill adapter;
[0167] FIGS. 199A-199H depicts a sequential cross sectional view of one
embodiment of the fill adapter in operation;
[0168] FIG. 200 is an exploded view of one embodiment of a fill adapter;
[0169] FIG. 201 is an isometric view of a fill adapter base according to
one embodiment;
[0170] FIG. 202A-202B are isometric views of the vial adapter according to
one embodiment;
[0171] FIGS. 203A-203K depicts a sequential cross sectional view of one
embodiment of the fill adapter in operation;
[0172] FIGS. 204A-204C is a cross section view of a sequence of the fill
adapter in operation, without a vial, according to one embodiment; and
[0173] FIG. 205 shows one embodiment of a system for verification of
volume and pumping.
[0174] Like reference symbols in the various drawings indicate like
elements.
DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE PREFERRED EMBODIMENTS
[0175] Referring to FIGS. 1-3, an infusion pump assembly 100 may include a
reusable housing assembly 102. Reusable housing assembly 102 may be
constructed from any suitable material, such as a hard or rigid plastic,
that will resist compression. For example, use of durable materials and
parts may improve quality and reduce costs by providing a reusable
portion that lasts longer and is more durable, providing greater
protection to components disposed therein.
[0176] Reusable housing assembly 102 may include mechanical control
assembly 104 having a pump assembly 106 and at least one valve assembly
108. Reusable housing assembly 102 may also include electrical control
assembly 110 configured to provide one or more control signals to
mechanical control assembly 104 and effectuate the basal and/or bolus
delivery of an infusible fluid to a user. Disposable housing assembly 114
may include valve assembly 108 which may be configured to control the
flow of the infusible fluid through a fluid path. Reusable housing
assembly 102 may also include pump assembly 106 which may be configured
to pump the infusible fluid from the fluid path to the user.
[0177] Electrical control assembly 110 may monitor and control the amount
of infusible fluid that has been and/or is being pumped. For example,
electrical control assembly 110 may receive signals from volume sensor
assembly 148 and calculate the amount of infusible fluid that has just
been dispensed and determine, based upon the dosage required by the user,
whether enough infusible fluid has been dispensed. If enough infusible
fluid has not been dispensed, electrical control assembly 110 may
determine that more infusible fluid should be pumped. Electrical control
assembly 110 may provide the appropriate signal to mechanical control
assembly 104 so that any additional necessary dosage may be pumped or
electrical control assembly 110 may provide the appropriate signal to
mechanical control assembly 104 so that the additional dosage may be
dispensed with the next dosage. Alternatively, if too much infusible
fluid has been dispensed, electrical control assembly 110 may provide the
appropriate signal to mechanical control assembly 104 so that less
infusible fluid may be dispensed in the next dosage.
[0178] Mechanical control assembly 104 may include at least one
shape-memory actuator 112. Pump assembly 106 and/or valve assembly 108 of
mechanical control assembly 104 may be actuated by at least one
shape-memory actuator, e.g., shape-memory actuator 112, which may be a
shape-memory wire in wire or spring configuration. Shape memory actuator
112 may be operably connected to and activated by electrical control
assembly 110, which may control the timing and the amount of heat and/or
electrical energy used to actuate mechanical control assembly 104. Shape
memory actuator 112 may be, for example, a conductive shape-memory alloy
wire that changes shape with temperature. The temperature of shape-memory
actuator 112 may be changed with a heater, or more conveniently, by
application of electrical energy. Shape memory actuator 112 may be a
shape memory wire constructed of nickel/titanium alloy, such as
NITINOL.TM. or FLEXINOL.RTM..
[0179] Infusion pump assembly 100 may include a volume sensor assembly 148
configured to monitor the amount of fluid infused by infusion pump
assembly 100. For example, volume sensor assembly 148 may employ, for
example, acoustic volume sensing. Acoustic volume measurement technology
is the subject of U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,575,310 and 5,755,683 assigned to DEKA
Products Limited Partnership, as well as U.S. patent application
Publication Nos. US 2007/0228071 A1, US 2007/0219496 A1, US 2007/0219480
A1, US 2007/0219597 A1, the entire disclosures of all of which are
incorporated herein by reference. Other alternative techniques for
measuring fluid flow may also be used; for example, Doppler-based
methods; the use of Hall-effect sensors in combination with a vane or
flapper valve; the use of a strain beam (for example, related to a
flexible member over a fluid reservoir to sense deflection of the
flexible member); the use of capacitive sensing with plates; or thermal
time of flight methods. One such alternative technique is disclosed in
U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/704,899, entitled Fluid Delivery
Systems and Methods, filed 9 Feb. 2007, the entire disclosure of which is
incorporated herein by reference. Infusion pump assembly 100 may be
configured so that the volume measurements produced by volume sensor
assembly 148 may be used to control, through a feedback loop, the amount
of infusible fluid that is infused into the user.
[0180] Infusion pump assembly 100 may further include a disposable housing
assembly 114. For example, disposable housing assembly 114 may be
configured for a single use or for use for a specified period of time,
e.g., three days or any other amount of time. Disposable housing assembly
114 may be configured such that any components in infusion pump assembly
100 that come in contact with the infusible fluid are disposed on and/or
within disposable housing assembly 114. For example, a fluid path or
channel including a reservoir, may be positioned within disposable
housing assembly 114 and may be configured for a single use or for a
specified number of uses before disposal. The disposable nature of
disposable housing assembly 114 may improve sanitation of infusion pump
assembly 100.
[0181] Referring also to FIG. 4, disposable housing assembly 114 may be
configured to releasably engage reusable housing assembly 102, and
includes a cavity 116 that has a reservoir 118 for receiving an infusible
fluid (not shown), e.g., insulin. Such releasable engagement may be
accomplished by a screw-on, a twist-lock or a compression fit
configuration, for example. Disposable housing assembly 114 and/or
reusable housing assembly 102 may include an alignment assembly
configured to assist in aligning disposable housing assembly 114 and
reusable housing assembly 102 for engagement in a specific orientation.
Similarly, base nub 120 and top nub 122 may be used as indicators of
alignment and complete engagement.
[0182] Cavity 116 may be at least partially formed by and integral to
disposable housing assembly 114. Cavity 116 may include a membrane
assembly 124 for at least partially defining reservoir 118. Reservoir 118
may be further defined by disposable housing assembly 114, e.g., by a
recess 126 formed in base portion 128 of disposable housing assembly 114.
For example, membrane assembly 124 may be disposed over recess 126 and
attached to base portion 128, thereby forming reservoir 118. Membrane
assembly 124 may be attached to base portion 128 by conventional means,
such as gluing, heat sealing, and/or compression fitting, such that a
seal 130 is formed between membrane assembly 124 and base portion 128.
Membrane assembly 124 may be flexible and the space formed between
membrane assembly 124 and recess 126 in base portion 128 may define
reservoir 118. Reservoir 118 may be non-pressurized and in fluid
communication with a fluid path (not shown). Membrane assembly 124 may be
at least partially collapsible and cavity 116 may include a vent
assembly, thereby advantageously preventing the buildup of a vacuum in
reservoir 118 as the infusible fluid is delivered from reservoir 118 to
the fluid path. In a preferred embodiment, membrane assembly 124 is fully
collapsible, thus allowing for the complete delivery of the infusible
fluid. Cavity 116 may be configured to provide sufficient space to ensure
there is always some air space even when reservoir 118 is filled with
infusible fluid.
[0183] The membranes and reservoirs described herein may be made from
materials including but not limited to silicone, NITRILE, and any other
material having desired resilience and properties for functioning as
described herein. Additionally, other structures could serve the same
purpose.
[0184] The use of a partially collapsible non pressurized reservoir may
advantageously prevent the buildup of air in the reservoir as the fluid
in the reservoir is depleted. Air buildup in a vented reservoir could
prevent fluid egress from the reservoir, especially if the system is
tilted so that an air pocket intervenes between the fluid contained in
the reservoir and the septum of the reservoir. Tilting of the system is
expected during normal operation as a wearable device.
[0185] Reservoir 118 may be conveniently sized to hold an insulin supply
sufficient for delivery over one or more days. For example, reservoir 118
may hold about 1.00 to 3.00 ml of insulin. A 3.00 ml insulin reservoir
may correspond to approximately a three day supply for about 90% of
potential users. In other embodiments, reservoir 118 may be any size or
shape and may be adapted to hold any amount of insulin or other infusible
fluid. In some embodiments, the size and shape of cavity 116 and
reservoir 118 is related to the type of infusible fluid that cavity 116
and reservoir 118 are adapted to hold.
[0186] Disposable housing assembly 114 may include a support member 132
(FIG. 3) configured to prevent accidental compression of reservoir 118.
Compression of reservoir 118 may result in an unintentional dosage of
infusible fluid being forced through the fluid path to the user. In a
preferred embodiment, reusable housing assembly 102 and disposable
housing assembly 114 may be constructed of a rigid material that is not
easily compressible. However, as an added precaution, support member 132
may be included within disposable housing assembly 114 to prevent
compression of infusion pump assembly 100 and cavity 116 therein. Support
member 132 may be a rigid projection from base portion 128. For example,
support member 132 may be disposed within cavity 116 and may prevent
compression of reservoir 118.
[0187] As discussed above, cavity 116 may be configured to provide
sufficient space to ensure there is always some air space even when
reservoir 118 is filled with infusible fluid. Accordingly, in the event
that infusion pump assembly 100 is accidentally compressed, the infusible
fluid may not be forced through cannula assembly 136 (e.g., shown in FIG.
9).
[0188] Cavity 116 may include a septum assembly 146 (FIG. 3) configured to
allow reservoir 118 to be filled with the infusible fluid. Septum
assembly 146 may be a conventional septum made from rubber or plastic and
have a one-way fluid valve configured to allow a user to fill reservoir
118 from a syringe or other filling device. In some embodiments, septum
146 may be located on the top of membrane assembly 124. In these
embodiments, cavity 116 may include a support structure (e.g., support
member 132 in FIG. 3) for supporting the area about the back side of the
septum so as to maintain the integrity of the septum seal when a needle
is introducing infusible fluid into cavity 116. The support structure may
be configured to support the septum while still allowing the introduction
of the needle for introducing infusible fluid into cavity 116.
[0189] Infusion pump assembly 100 may include an overfill prevention
assembly (not shown) that may e.g., protrude into cavity 116 and may
e.g., prevent the overfilling of reservoir 118.
[0190] In some embodiments, reservoir 118 may be configured to be filled a
plurality of times. For example, reservoir 118 may be refillable through
septum assembly 146. As infusible fluid may be dispensed to a user,
electronic control assembly 110 may monitor the fluid level of the
infusible fluid in reservoir 118. When the fluid level reaches a low
point, electronic control assembly 110 may provide a signal, such as a
light or a vibration, to the user that reservoir 118 needs to be
refilled. A syringe, or other filling device, may be used to fill
reservoir 118 through septum 146.
[0191] Reservoir 118 may be configured to be filled a single time. For
example, a refill prevention assembly (not shown) may be utilized to
prevent the refilling of reservoir 118, such that disposable housing
assembly 114 may only be used once. The refill prevention assembly (not
shown) may be a mechanical device or an electro-mechanical device. For
example, insertion of a syringe into septum assembly 146 for filling
reservoir 118 may trigger a shutter to close over septum 146 after a
single filling, thus preventing future access to septum 146. Similarly, a
sensor may indicate to electronic control assembly 110 that reservoir 118
has been filled once and may trigger a shutter to close over septum 146
after a single filling, thus preventing future access to septum 146.
Other means of preventing refilling may be utilized and are considered to
be within the scope of this disclosure.
[0192] As discussed above, disposable housing assembly 114 may include
septum assembly 146 that may be configured to allow reservoir 118 to be
filled with the infusible fluid. Septum assembly 146 may be a
conventional septum made from rubber or any other material that may
function as a septum, or, in other embodiments, septum assembly 146 may
be, but is not limited to, a plastic, or other material, one-way fluid
valve. In various embodiments, including the exemplary embodiment, septum
assembly 146 is configured to allow a user to fill reservoir 118 from a
syringe or other filling device. Disposable housing assembly 114 may
include a septum access assembly that may be configured to limit the
number of times that the user may refill reservoir 118.
[0193] For example and referring also to FIGS. 5A-5C, septum access
assembly 152 may include shutter assembly 154 that may be held in an
"open" position by a tab assembly 156 that is configured to fit within a
slot assembly 158. Upon penetrating septum 146 with filling syringe 160,
shutter assembly 154 may be displaced downward, resulting in tab assembly
156 disengaging from slot assembly 158. Once disengaged, spring assembly
162 may displace shutter assembly 154 in the direction of arrow 164,
resulting in septum 146 no longer being accessible to the user.
[0194] Referring also to FIG. 6A, an alternative-embodiment septum access
assembly 166 is shown in the "open" position. In a fashion similar to
that of septum access assembly 152, septum access assembly 166 includes
shutter assembly 168 and spring assembly 170.
[0195] Referring also to FIG. 6B, an alternative-embodiment of septum
access assembly 172 is shown in the "open" position where tab 178 may
engage slot 180. In a fashion similar to that of septum access assembly
166, septum access assembly 172 may include shutter assembly 174 and
spring assembly 176. Once shutter assembly 172 moves to the "closed"
position (e.g., which may prevent further access of septum 146 by the
user), tab 178 may at least partially engage slot 180a. Engagement
between tab 178 and slot 180a may lock shutter assembly 172 in the
"closed" position to inhibit tampering and reopening of shutter assembly
172. Spring tab 182 of shutter assembly 172 may bias tab 178 into
engagement with slot 180a.
[0196] However, in various embodiments, septum access assemblies may not
be actuated linearly. For example and referring also to FIGS. 7A-7B,
there is shown alternative embodiment septum access assembly 184 that
includes shutter assembly 186 that is configured to pivot about axis 188.
When positioned in the open position (as shown in FIG. 7A), septum 146
may be accessible due to passage 190 (in shutter assembly 186) being
aligned with passage 192 in e.g., a surface of disposable housing
assembly 114. However, in a fashion similar to septum access assemblies
166, 172, upon penetrating septum 146 with filling syringe 160 (See FIG.
6B), shutter assembly 186 may be displaced in a clockwise fashion,
resulting in passage 190 (in shutter assembly 186) no longer being
aligned with passage 192 in e.g., a surface of disposable housing
assembly 114, thus preventing access to septum 146.
[0197] Referring also to FIGS. 8A-8B, an alternative-embodiment septum
access assembly 194 is shown. In a fashion similar to that of septum
access assemblies 166, 172, septum access assembly 194 includes shutter
assembly 196 and spring assembly 198 that is configured to bias shutter
assembly 196 in the direction of arrow 200. Filling assembly 202 may be
used to fill reservoir 118. Filling assembly 202 may include shutter
displacement assembly 204 that may be configured to displace shutter
assembly 196 in the direction of arrow 206, which in turn aligns passage
208 in shutter assembly 196 with septum 146 and passage 210 in septum
access assembly 194, thus allowing filling syringe assembly 212 to
penetrate septum 146 and fill reservoir 118.
[0198] Infusion pump assembly 100 may include a sealing assembly 150 (FIG.
3) configured to provide a seal between reusable housing assembly 102 and
disposable housing assembly 114.
[0199] For example, when reusable housing assembly 102 and disposable
housing assembly 114 are engaged by e.g. rotational screw-on engagement,
twist-lock engagement or compression engagement, reusable housing
assembly 102 and disposable housing assembly 114 may fit together
snuggly, thus forming a seal. In some embodiments, it may be desirable
for the seal to be more secure. Accordingly, sealing assembly 150 may
include an o-ring assembly (not shown). Alternatively, sealing assembly
150 may include an over molded seal assembly (not shown). The use of an
o-ring assembly or an over molded seal assembly may make the seal more
secure by providing a compressible rubber or plastic layer between
reusable housing assembly 102 and disposable housing assembly 114 when
engaged thus preventing penetration by outside fluids. In some instances,
the o-ring assembly may prevent inadvertent disengagement. For example,
sealing assembly 150 may be a watertight seal assembly and, thus, enable
a user to wear infusion pump assembly 100 while swimming, bathing or
exercising.
[0200] Referring also to FIG. 9, infusion pump assembly 100 may include an
external infusion set 134 configured to deliver the infusible fluid to a
user. External infusion set 134 may be in fluid communication with cavity
118, e.g. by way of the fluid path. External infusion set 134 may be
disposed adjacent to infusion pump assembly 100. Alternatively, external
infusion set 134 may be configured for application remote from infusion
pump assembly 100, as discussed in greater detail below. External
infusion set 134 may include a cannula assembly 136, which may include a
needle or a disposable cannula 138, and tubing assembly 140. Tubing
assembly 140 may be in fluid communication with reservoir 118, for
example, by way of the fluid path, and with cannula assembly 138 for
example, either directly or by way of a cannula interface 142.
[0201] External infusion set 134 may be a tethered infusion set, as
discussed above regarding application remote from infusion pump assembly
100. For example, external infusion set 134 may be in fluid communication
with infusion pump assembly 100 through tubing assembly 140, which may be
of any length desired by the user (e.g., 3-18 inches). Though infusion
pump assembly 100 may be worn on the skin of a user with the use of
adhesive patch 144, the length of tubing assembly 140 may enable the user
to alternatively wear infusion pump assembly 100 in a pocket. This may be
beneficial to users whose skin is easily irritated by application of
adhesive patch 144. Similarly, wearing and/or securing infusion pump
assembly 100 in a pocket may be preferable for users engaged in physical
activity.
[0202] In addition to/as an alternative to adhesive patch 144, a hook and
loop fastener system (e.g. such as hook and loop fastener systems offered
by Velcro USA Inc. of Manchester, N.H.) may be utilized to allow for easy
attachment/removal of an infusion pump assembly (e.g., infusion pump
assembly 100) from the user. Accordingly, adhesive patch 144 may be
attached to the skin of the user and may include an outward facing hook
or loop surface. Additionally, the lower surface of disposable housing
assembly 114 may include a complementary hook or loop surface. Depending
upon the separation resistance of the particular type of hook and loop
fastener system employed, it may be possible for the strength of the hook
and loop connection to be stronger than the strength of the adhesive to
skin connection. Accordingly, various hook and loop surface patterns may
be utilized to regulate the strength of the hook and loop connection.
[0203] Referring also to FIGS. 10A-10E, five examples of such hook and
loop surface patterns are shown. Assume for illustrative purposes that
the entire lower surface of disposable housing assembly 114 is covered in
a "loop" material. Accordingly, the strength of the hook and loop
connection may be regulated by varying the pattern (i.e., amount) of the
"hook" material present on the surface of adhesive patch 144. Examples of
such patterns may include but are not limited to: a singular outer circle
220 of "hook" material (as shown in FIG. 10A); a plurality of concentric
circles 222, 224 of "hook" material (as shown in FIG. 10B); a plurality
of radial spokes 226 of "hook" material (as shown in FIG. 10C); a
plurality of radial spokes 228 of "hook" material in combination with a
single outer circle 230 of "hook" material (as shown in FIG. 10D); and a
plurality of radial spokes 232 of "hook" material in combination with a
plurality of concentric circles 234, 236 of "hook" material (as shown in
FIG. 10E).
[0204] Additionally and referring also to FIG. 11A, in one exemplary
embodiment of the above-described infusion pump assembly, infusion pump
assembly 100' may be configured via a remote control assembly 300. In
this particular embodiment, infusion pump assembly 100' may include
telemetry circuitry (not shown) that allows for communication (e.g.,
wired or wireless) between infusion pump assembly 100' and e.g., remote
control assembly 300, thus allowing remote control assembly 300 to
remotely control infusion pump assembly 100'. Remote control assembly 300
(which may also include telemetry circuitry (not shown) and may be
capable of communicating with infusion pump assembly 100') may include
display assembly 302 and input assembly 304. Input assembly 304 may
include slider assembly 306 and switch assemblies 308, 310. In other
embodiments, the input assembly may include a jog wheel, a plurality of
switch assemblies, or the like.
[0205] Remote control assembly 300 may include the ability to pre-program
basal rates, bolus alarms, delivery limitations, and allow the user to
view history and to establish user preferences. Remote control assembly
300 may also include a glucose strip reader.
[0206] During use, remote control assembly 300 may provide instructions to
infusion pump assembly 100' via wireless communication channel 312
established between remote control assembly 300 and infusion pump
assembly 100'. Accordingly, the user may use remote control assembly 300
to program/configure infusion pump assembly 100'. Some or all of the
communication between remote control assembly 300 and infusion pump
assembly 100' may be encrypted to provide an enhanced level of security.
[0207] Communication between remote control assembly 300 and infusion pump
assembly 100' may be accomplished utilizing a standardized communication
protocol. Further, communication between the various components included
within infusion pump assembly 100, 100' may be accomplished using the
same protocol. One example of such a communication protocol is the Packet
Communication Gateway Protocol (PCGP) developed by DEKA Research &
Development of Manchester, N.H. As discussed above, infusion pump
assembly 100, 100' may include electrical control assembly 110 that may
include one or more electrical components. For example, electrical
control assembly 110 may include a plurality of data processors (e.g. a
supervisor processor and a command processor) and a radio processor for
allowing infusion pump assembly 100, 100' to communicate with remote
control assembly 300. Further, remote control assembly 300 may include
one or more electrical components, examples of which may include but are
not limited to a command processor and a radio processor for allowing
remote control assembly 300 to communicate with infusion pump assembly
100, 100'. A high-level diagrammatic view of one example of such a system
is shown in FIG. 11B.
[0208] Each of these electrical components may be manufactured from a
different component provider and, therefore, may utilize native (i.e.
unique) communication commands. Accordingly, through the use of a
standardized communication protocol, efficient communication between such
disparate components may be accomplished.
[0209] PCGP may be a flexible extendable software module that may be used
on the processors within infusion pump assembly 100, 100' and remote
control assembly 300 to build and route packets. PCGP may abstract the
various interfaces and may provide a unified application programming
interface (API) to the various applications being executed on each
processor. PCGP may also provide an adaptable interface to the various
drivers. For illustrative purposes only, PCGP may have the conceptual
structure illustrated in FIG. 11C for any given processor.
[0210] PCGP may ensure data integrity by utilizing cyclic redundancy
checks (CRCs). PCGP may also provide guaranteed delivery status. For
example, all new messages should have a reply. If such a reply isn't sent
back in time, the message may time out and PCGP may generate a negative
acknowledge reply message for the application (i.e., a NACK).
Accordingly, the message-reply protocol may let the application know
whether the application should retry sending a message.
[0211] PCGP may also limit the number of messages in-flight from a given
node, and may be coupled with a flow-control mechanism at the driver
level to provide a deterministic approach to message delivery and may let
individual nodes have different quantities of buffers without dropping
packets. As a node runs out of buffers, drivers may provide back pressure
to other nodes and prevent sending of new messages.
[0212] PCGP may use a shared buffer pool strategy to minimize data copies,
and may avoid mutual exclusions, which may have a small affect on the API
used to send/receive messages to the application, and a larger affect on
the drivers. PCGP may use a "Bridge" base class that provides routing and
buffer ownership. The main PCGP class may be sub-classed from the bridge
base class. Drivers may either be derived from a bridge class, or talk to
or own a derived bridge class.
[0213] PCGP may be designed to work in an embedded environment with or
without an operating system by using a semaphore to protect shared data
such that some calls can be re-entrant and run on a multiple threads. One
illustrative example of such an implementation is shown in FIG. 11D. PCGP
may operate the same way in both environments, but there may be versions
of the call for specific processor types (e.g., the ARM 9/OS version). So
while the functionality may be the same, there may be an operating system
abstraction layer with slightly different calls tailored for e.g., the
ARM 9 Nucleus OS environment.
[0214] Referring also to FIG. 11E, PCGP may: [0215] allow multiple
Send/Reply calls to occur (on Pilot's ARM 9 on multiple tasks
re-entrant); [0216] have multiple drivers running asynchronously for RX
and TX on different interfaces; and [0217] provide packet ordering for
send/receive, and deterministic timeout on message send.
[0218] Each software object may ask the buffer manager for the next buffer
to use, and may then give that buffer to another object. Buffers may pass
from one exclusive owner to another autonomicly, and queues may occur
automatically by ordering buffers by sequence number. When a buffer is no
longer in use, the buffer may be recycled (e.g., object attempts to give
the buffer to itself, or frees it for the buffer manager to re-allocate
later). Accordingly, data generally doesn't need to be copied, and
routing simply writes over the buffer ownership byte.
[0219] Such an implementation of PCGP may provide various benefits,
examples of which may include but are not limited to: [0220] dropping a
message due to lack of buffers may be impossible, as once a message is
put into a buffer, the message may live there until it is transferred or
received by the application; [0221] data may not need to be copied, as
offsets are used to access driver, PCGP and payload sections of a buffer;
[0222] drivers may exchange ownership of message data by writing over one
byte (i.e., the buffer ownership byte); [0223] there may be no need for
multiple exclusions except for re-entrant calls, as a mutual exclusion
may be needed only when a single buffer owner could simultaneously want
to use a buffer or get a new sequence number; [0224] there may be fewer
rules for application writers to follow to implement a reliable system;
[0225] drivers may use ISR/push/pull and polled data models, as there are
a set of calls provided to push/pull data out of the buffer management
system from the drivers; [0226] drivers may not do much work beyond TX
and RX, as drivers may not copy, CRC or check anything but the
destination byte and CRC and other checks may be done off of the ISR hot
path later; [0227] as the buffer manager may order access by sequence
number, queue ordering may automatically occur; and [0228] a small
code/variable foot print may be utilized; hot path code may be small and
overhead may be low.
[0229] As shown in FIG. 11F, when a message needs to be sent, the PCGP may
build the packet quickly and may insert it into the buffer management
system. Once in the buffer management system, a call to "packetProcessor"
may apply protocol rules and may give the messages to the
drivers/application.
[0230] To send a new message or send a reply, PCGP may: [0231] check the
call arguments to e.g., make sure the packet length is legal, destination
is ok, etc.; [0232] avoid trying to send a message across a link that is
down unless the down link is the radio node, which may allow PCGP to be
used by the radio processors to establish a link, pair, etc. and may
notify the application when PCGP is trying to talk across a link that is
not functional (instead of timing out); [0233] obtain a sequence number
for a new message or utilize an existing sequence number for an existing
message; [0234] build the packet, copy the payload data and write in the
CRC, wherein (from this point forward) the packet integrity may be
protected by the CRC; and [0235] either give the message to the buffer
manager as a reply or as a new message, and check to see if putting this
buffer into the buffer manager would exceed the maximum number of
en-queued send messages.
[0236] Referring also to FIGS. 11G-11H, PCGP may work by doing all of the
main work on one thread to avoid mutual exclusions, and to avoid doing
considerable work on the send/reply or driver calls. The
"packetProcessor" call may have to apply protocol rules to replies, new
sent messages, and received messages. Reply messages may simply get
routed, but new messages and received messages may have rules for routing
the messages. In each case, the software may loop while a message of the
right type is available to apply protocol rules until it cannot process
the packets.
[0237] Sending a new message may conform to the following rules: [0238]
only two messages may be allowed "in-flight" on the network; and [0239]
enough data about an in-flight message may be stored to match the
response and handle timeout.
[0240] Receiving a message may conform to the following rules: [0241]
responses that match may clear out the "in-flight" information slot so a
new packet can be sent; [0242] responses that do not match may be
dropped; [0243] new messages may be for the protocol (e.g.,
getting/clearing network statistics for this node); [0244] to receive a
message, the buffer may be given up to the application and may use a call
back; and [0245] the buffer may be freed or left owned by the
application.
[0246] Accordingly, PCGP may be configured such that: [0247] the call
back function may copy the payload data out or may use it completely
before returning; [0248] the call back function owns the buffer and may
reference the buffer and the buffer's payload by the payload address,
wherein the message may be processed later; [0249] applications may poll
the PCGP system for received messages; and [0250] applications may use
the call back to set an event and then poll for received messages.
[0251] The communication system may have a limited number of buffers. When
PCGP runs out of buffers, drivers may stop receiving new packets and the
application may be told that the application cannot send new packets. To
avoid this and maintain optimal performance, the application may try to
perform one or more procedures, examples of which may include but are not
limited to: [0252] a) The application should keep PCGP up to date with
radio status: Specifically, if the link goes down and PCGP doesn't know,
PCGP may accept and queue new messages to send (or not timeout messages
optimally), which may jam the send queue and delay the application from
using the link optimally. [0253] b) The application should call
"decrement timeouts" regularly: Optimally, every 20-100 milliseconds
unless the processor is asleep. In general, a message moves fast
(milliseconds) slow (seconds) or not at all. Timeouts are an attempt to
remove "in-flight" messages that should be dropped to free up buffers and
bandwidth. Doing this less often may delay when a new message gets sent,
or when the application can queue a new message. [0254] c) The
application should ask PCGP if it has work to do that is pending before
going to sleep: If PCGP has nothing to do, driver activity may wake up
the system and thus PCGP, and then PCGP won't need a call to
"packetProcessor" or "decrement timeouts" until new packets enter the
system. Failure to do this may cause messages that could have been
sent/forwarded/received successfully to be dropped due to a timeout
condition. [0255] d) The application should not hold onto received
messages indefinitely: The message system relies on prompt replies. If
the application is sharing PCGP buffers, then holding onto a message
means holding onto a PCGP buffer. The receiving node doesn't know if the
sending node has timeout configured for slow or fast radio. This means
when a node receives a message it should assume the network's fast
timeout speed. [0256] e) The application should call the
"packetProcessor" often: The call may cause new messages queued by the
application to get sent and may handle receipt of new messages. The call
may also cause buffers to re-allocate and calling it infrequently may
delay message traffic.
[0257] As shown in FIG. 11I, at some point the RX driver may be asked to
receive a message from the other side of the interface. To ensure a
message does not get dropped, the RX driver may ask the buffer manager if
there is an available buffer for storing a new message. The driver may
then ask for a buffer pointer and may start filling the buffer with
received data. When a complete message is received, the RX driver may
call a function to route the packet. The route function may examine the
destination byte in the packet header and may change the owner to either
the other driver, or the application, or may detect that the packet is
bad and may drop the packet by freeing the buffer.
[0258] PCGP RX overhead may consist of asking for the next available
buffer and calling the route function. An example of code that performs
such a function is as follows:
TABLE-US-00001
@ Receive request
uint8 i=0, *p;
if (Bridge::canReceiveFlowControl( ) )
{
p = Bridge::nextBufferRX( );
while (not done) { p[i] = the next byte; }
Bridge::route(p);
}
[0259] A driver may perform a TX by asking the buffer manager for the
pointer to the next buffer to send. The TX driver may then ask the other
side of the interface if it can accept a packet. If the other side denies
the packet, the TX driver may do nothing to the buffer, as its status has
not changed. Otherwise, the driver may send the packet and may
recycle/free the buffer. An example of code that performs such a function
is as follows:
TABLE-US-00002
uint8 *p = Bridge::nextBufferTX( );
if (p != (uint8 *)0)
{
send the buffer p;
Bridge::recycle(p);
}
[0260] To avoid forwarding packets that are past the maximum message
system timeout time, asking for the nextBuffer may call the
BufferManager::first(uint8 owner) function that may scan for buffers to
free. Accordingly, full TX buffers with no hope of making a timeout may
be freed on the thread that owns the buffer. A bridge that is doing TX
(i.e., while looking for the next TX buffer) may free all of the TX
buffers that are expired before receiving the next TX buffer for
processing.
[0261] As shown in FIG. 11J-11L, during the buffer allocation process,
buffers marked free may be transferred to the drivers to receive new
packets, or to PCGP to receive new payloads for TX. Allocation from
"free" may be done by the "packetProcessor" function. The number of sends
and receives between "packetProcessor" calls may dictate how many
LT_Driver_RX, GT_Driver_RX and PCGP_Free buffers need to be allocated.
LT_Driver may represent drivers that handle addresses that are less than
the node address. GT_Driver may represent drivers that handle addresses
that are greater than the node address.
[0262] When a driver receives a packet, the driver may put the data into
an RX buffer that gets handed to the router. The router may then reassign
the buffer to PCGP_Receive or to the other driver's TX (not shown). If
the buffer contains obviously invalid data, the buffer may transition to
free.
[0263] After a router marks a buffer for TX, the driver may discover the
buffer is TX and may send the message. After sending the message, the
buffer may immediately become an RX buffer if the driver was low in RX
buffers, or the buffer may be freed for re-allocation.
[0264] During the "packetProcessor" call, PCGP may process all buffers
that the router marked as PCGP_Receive. At this point, data may be acted
upon, so the CRC and other data items may be checked. If the data is
corrupted, a statistic may be incremented and the buffer may be freed.
Otherwise, the buffer may be marked as owned by the application. Buffers
marked as owned by the application may be either recycled for the use of
PCGP or freed for reallocation by the buffer manager.
[0265] When the application wants to send a new message, it may be done in
a re-entrant friendly/mutual exclusion manner. If the buffer may be
allocated, PCGP may mark the buffer as busy. Once marked busy, no other
thread calling the send or reply functions may grab this buffer, as it is
owned by this function call's invocation. The remainder of the process of
error checking and building the message may be done outside the isolated
race condition mutual exclusion guarded code. The buffer may either
transition to free or may become a valid filled CRC-checked buffer and
passed to the router. These buffers may not be routed immediately and may
be queued so that messages can be sent later (assuming that protocol
rules allow). Reply messages may be marked differently than new send
messages because reply messages may be routed with a higher priority than
regular send messages and reply messages may have no rules limiting how
many/when they can be sent.
[0266] PCGP was designed to work with flow control, and flow control may
negotiate the transfer of messages from one node to another node so that
a buffer is never dropped because the other side of an interface lacks a
buffer (which may cause back pressure on the sending node).
[0267] Flow control may be apart of the shared buffer format. The first
two bytes may be reserved for the driver so that the driver never needs
to shift the packet bytes. Two bytes may be used so that one byte is the
DMA length-1, and the second byte is to control the flow of messages.
These same two bytes may be synchronizing bytes if a PCGP message is
transmitted over RS232.
[0268] When a packet is "in-flight", the packet may be in the process of
being sent by a driver on the way to its destination, being processed by
the destination, or being sent back as a response.
[0269] Typical delays are as follows:
TABLE-US-00003
Interface/Delay
cause Delay (seconds) Notes
SPI <3 Roughly 400 kbps
I2C <1
Waking a CC2510 <6? Clock calibration, min.
sleep time.
Flow control <0.2
RF link 20 to 2000
Interference/ Minutes, never
separation
[0270] Accordingly, messages tend to complete the round trip either:
quickly (e.g., <50 ms); slowly (e.g., one or more seconds); or not at
all.
[0271] PCGP may use two different times (set at initialization) for all
timeouts, one for when the RF link is in fast heartbeat mode, and another
for when the RF link is in slow mode. If a message is in-flight and the
link status changes from fast to slow, the timeout may be adjusted and
the difference between fast and slow may be added to the time-to-live
counter for the packet. No additional transitions back and forth may
affect the time-to-live time for the message. There is a second timeout
that may be twice as long as the slow timeout that is used to monitor
buffer allocation inside PCGP. Accordingly, if a message is "stuck"
inside a driver and hasn't been sent due to e.g., flow control or
hardware damage, the buffer may be freed by the buffer manager, resulting
in the buffer being dropped. For a "new" message, this may mean that the
packet already timed out and the application was already given a reply
saying the message wasn't delivered, resulting in the buffer being freed.
Since the driver polls the buffer manager for buffers that need to be
sent, the buffer is freed up so that a message that could be sent is
handed to the driver the next time that it unblocks. For a reply message,
the reply may simply get dropped and the sending node may time out.
[0272] The PCGP messaging system may pass messages that contain header
information and payload. Outside of PCGP, the header may be a set of data
items in a call signature. However, internal to PCGP, there may be a
consistent, driver friendly byte layout. Drivers may insert bytes either
into the PCGP packet or before the PCGP packet such: [0273] DE, CA:
Synch bytes for use with RS232, nominal value of 0xDE, 0xCA or 0x5A,
0xA5. [0274] LD: Driver DMA length byte, equals amount driver is pushing
in this DMA transfer, which is the total size, not including the size
byte or synch bytes. [0275] Cmd: Driver command and control byte used for
flow control. [0276] LP: PCGP packet length, always the total
header+payload size in bytes+CRC size. LD=LP+1. [0277] Dst: Destination
address. [0278] Src: Source address [0279] Cmd: Command byte [0280] Scd:
Sub command byte [0281] AT: Application Tag is defined by the application
and has no significance to PCGP. It allows the application to attach more
information to a message e.g., the thread from which the message
originated. [0282] SeqNum: thirty-two bit sequence number is incremented
by PCGP for a new message sent, guarantees the number will not wrap, acts
as a token, endianess isn't relevant. [0283] CRC16: A sixteen bit CRC of
the PCGP header and payload.
[0284] An example of a message with no payload, cmd=1, subcmd=2 is as
follows: [0285] 0xDE, 0xCA, 0xC, 0x5, 0x14, 1, 2, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0x1,
crchigh, crclow. [0286] 0x0D, cmd, 0xC, 0x5, 0x14, 1, 2, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0x1,
crchigh, crclow.
[0287] There may be several advantages to this methodology, examples of
which may include but are not limited to: [0288] Most of our hardware
DMA engines may use the first byte to define how many additional bytes to
move, so in this methodology, drivers and PCGP may share buffers. [0289]
A byte may be provided right after the DMA length to pass flow control
information between drivers. [0290] Driver length and "Cmd" byte may be
outside the CRC region so they may be altered by the driver, may be owned
by the driver transport mechanism, and the driver may guard for invalid
lengths. [0291] There may be a separate PGCP packet length byte that is
CRC protected. Accordingly, the application may trust the that payload
length is correct. [0292] The endianness of the sequence number may not
be relevant, as it is just a byte pattern that may be matched that
happens to also be a thirty-two bit integer. [0293] The sequence number
may be four bytes aligned to the edge of the shared buffer pool length.
[0294] There may be optional RS232 synchronizing bytes so that users may
move cables around while debugging a message stream and both sides of the
interface may resynchronize. [0295] The application, driver and PCGP may
share buffers and may release them by pointer.
[0296] PCGP may not be an event driven software design, but may be used in
event driven architectures by how the sub-classes are written. Data may
be exchanged between the classes conceptually (as shown in FIG. 11M-11N).
[0297] Some event model in the driver may wake the driver, may receive a
message and may pass the message through the bridge into the buffer
manager that routes the message to new owner of the new message (through
a bridge to either a driver or PCGP).
[0298] The following summarizes some exemplary events:
TABLE-US-00004
Event: Possible use: Where this occurs:
When a new send or reply Decide to run Inside
is queued, or decTimeouts packetProcessor. PCGP::sendInternal
generates a timeout reply.
When a messages is Decide to run BufferManager::give
received for PCGP. packetProcessor.
When a driver has Wake driver for TX. BufferManager::give
something new to send.
When a Driver RX buffer Turn off flow BufferManager::give
becomes available. control.
[0299] The following illustrative example shows how the PCGP event model
may work with Nucleus to wakeup the PCGP task after every message send,
reply, or decTimeout that generated a NACK:
TABLE-US-00005
class PcgpOS : public Pcgp
{
virtual void schedulePacketProcessor(void)
{
OS_EventGrp_Set(g_RCVEvGrps[EVG_RF_TASK].pEvgHandle,
RfRadioTxEvent, OS_EV_OR_NO_CLEAR);
}
}
[0300] The following is a pseudo code driver that is event based,
illustrating how driver events work. The Driver subclasses Bridge and
overrides hasMessagesToSend and flowControlTurnedOff to schedule the TX
and RX functions to run if they aren't already running.
TABLE-US-00006
class SPI_Driver : public Bridge
{
virtual void hasMessagesToSend( )
{
Trigger_ISR(TX_ISR, this);
}
virtual void flowControlTurnedOff( )
{
Trigger_ISR(RX_ISR, this);
}
static void TX_RetryTimer( )
{
Trigger_ISR(TX_ISR, this);
}
static void TX_ISR(Bridge *b)
{
DisableISRs( );
do
{
uint8 *p = b->nextBufferTX( );
if (p == null) break;
if (b->_bufferManager->bufferTimedOut(p)==false)
{
if (OtherSideSPI_FlowControl( ) == false)
{
Trigger TX_RetryTimer in 20 msec.
break;
}
send(p);
}
free(p);
} while (true) ;
EnableISRs( );
}
static void RX_ISR(Bridge *b)
{
DisableISRs( );
do
{
uint8* p = b->nextBufferRX( );
if (p == null) break;
uint i;
while (not done receiving)
p[i++] = getChar( );
b->route (p);
} while (true) ;
EnableISRs( );
}
}
[0301] The following statistics may be supported by PCGP: [0302] Number
of packets sent; [0303] Number of packets received; [0304] CRC errors;
[0305] Timeouts; and [0306] Buffer unavailable (ran out of buffers)
[0307] PCGP may be designed to run in multiple processing environments.
Most parameters may be run time configured because it facilitates
testing, and any run time fine tuning for performance. Other parameters
may be compile time e.g., anything that alters memory allocation must be
done statically at compile time.
[0308] The following may be compile time configuration #defines that may
vary where PCGP is implemented: [0309] # driver bytes: may be two bytes
reserved in the common buffer scheme for the driver, but this may be a
compile time option to accommodate other drivers such as RF protocol.
[0310] # RX driver buffers: may be tuned to how many buffers would be
good for that processor/traffic flow, etc. [0311] # PCGP RX buffers: may
be tuned to how many buffers would be good for that processor/traffic
flow, etc. [0312] Total # of buffers: may be tuned to how many buffers
should be at that processor.
[0313] The CRC may be used to ensure data integrity. If a CRC is invalid,
it may not be delivered to the application and the CRC error may be
tracked. The message may eventually timeout and may be retried by the
originator.
[0314] Likewise, if the messaging system informs the application that a
message was delivered when it was not, this may be a hazard to the
system. The Stop Bolus Command is an example of such a command. This may
be mitigated by the Request/Action sequence of messages which may be
required by the application to change therapy. The Controller may receive
a matching command from the Pump application to consider the message
delivered.
[0315] DEKA may provide a reference way of interfacing PCGP into the
Nucleus OS system on the ARM 9 (as shown in FIG. 110).
[0316] As shown in FIG. 11P, the pcgpOS.cpp file may instantiate a PCGP
node instance (Pcgp, a Bridge, etc.) and may provide through pcgpOS.h a
`C` linkable set of function calls that provide a `C` language interface
to the C++ code. This may simplify the `C` code as the objects acted upon
are implicit.
[0317] The following general rules may be applied: [0318] PCGP may run
on all nodes: any driver may support a generic driver interface. [0319]
Race conditions may not be permitted. [0320] May support half duplex on
the SPI port between slave processor and master processor. [0321] Data
transfer may not be attempted; as it either succeeds or returns
fail/false. [0322] May require low overhead (time, processing, bandwidth
wasted). [0323] May support CC2510 operating at DMA (fast) SPI clock
rates.
[0324] SPI flow control may prevent data from being sent if the receiving
side does not currently have an empty buffer to place the packet. This
may be accomplished by asking for permission to send and waiting for a
response indicating that you have been cleared to do so. There may also
be a way to tell the other side that there are currently no free buffers
and the transfer should be attempted at a later time.
[0325] All transmission may begin with a length byte that indicates the
number of bytes to be sent, not including the length byte itself.
Following the length may be a single byte indicating the command being
sent.
[0326] The actual transmission of a packet may be the length of packet
plus one for the command byte, followed by the command byte for a message
appended and finally the packet itself.
[0327] In addition to the command bytes that will be sent, an additional
hardware line called the FlowControl line may be added to the traditional
four SPI signals. The purpose of this line is to allow the protocol to
run as quickly as possible without a need for preset delays. It also
allows the slave processor to tell the master processor that it has a
packet waiting to be sent, thus eliminating the need for the master
processor to poll the slave processor for status.
[0328] The following exemplary command values may be used:
Commands to be Sent by the Master Processor:
TABLE-US-00007
[0329] Command Value Description
M_RTS 0xC1 Master is requesting
to send a packet
M_MSG_APPENDED 0xC2 Master is sending a packet
M_CTS 0xC3 Master is tell slave it is
Cleared to Send
M_ERROR 0xC4 An Error condition has
been encountered
Commands to be Sent by the Slave Processor:
TABLE-US-00008
[0330] Command Value Description
S_PREPARING_FOR_RX 0xA1 Slave is prepare the dma to
receive a packet
S_RX_BUFF_FULL 0xA2 Slave is currently out of
RX buffers, retry later
S_MSG_APPENDED 0xA3 Slave is sending a packet
S_ERROR 0xA4 An Error condition has been
encountered
[0331] As illustrated in FIG. 11Q, when the slave processor has a packet
to send to the master processor, the slave processor may notify the
master processor (by asserting the FlowControl line) that it has a
pending packet that is waiting to be sent. Doing so may result in an IRQ
on the master processor at which time the master processor may decide
when to go retrieve the message from the slave processor. Retrieving the
packet may be delayed at the discretion of the master processor, and the
master processor may even decide to attempt to send a packet to the slave
processor before retrieving from the slave processor.
[0332] The master processor may begin the retrieval by sending the slave
processor M_CTS commands; this shall be repeated until the slave
processor responds by sending the S_MSG_APPENDED command along with the
packet itself. The FlowControl line may be cleared after the packet has
been sent. If a M_CTS command is received by the slave processor when one
is not expected, the M_CTS command may be ignored.
[0333] As illustrated in FIG. 11R, when the master processor has a packet
to send to the slave processor, the master processor may initiate the
transfer by sending a M_RTS command. Upon receiving the M_RTS command, if
the slave processor currently has a send packet pending, the slave
processor will lower the FlowControl line so that it may be re-used as a
Cleared To Send signal. The slave processor may then tell the master
processor that it is in the process of preparing the SPI DMA to receive
the packet, during which time the master processor may stop clocking
bytes onto the bus and may allow the slave processor to finish preparing
for the receive.
[0334] The slave processor may then indicate it is ready to receive the
full packet by raising the FlowControl line (which is now used as the CTS
signal). Upon receiving the CTS signal, the master processor may proceed
to send the M_MSG_APPENDED command along with the packet itself.
[0335] After the completion of the transfer, the slave processor may lower
the FlowControl line. If a packet was pending at the start of the
transfer, or a send occurred on the slave processor when the packet was
being received, the slave processor may reassert the FlowControl line now
indicating that it has a pending packet.
[0336] Referring again to FIG. 11A, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' may
include switch assembly 318 coupled to electrical control assembly 110
(FIG. 3) that may allow a user (not shown) to perform at least one, and
in some embodiments, a plurality of tasks. One illustrative example of
such a task is the administration of a bolus dose of the infusible fluid
(e.g., insulin) without the use of a display assembly. Remote control
assembly 300 may allow the user to enable/disable/configure infusion pump
assembly 100, 100' to administer the bolus dose of insulin.
[0337] Referring also to FIG. 12A, slider assembly 306 may be configured,
at least in part, to enable the user to manipulate the menu-based
information rendered on display assembly 302. An example of slider
assembly 306 may include a capacitive slider assembly, which may be
implemented using a CY8C21434-24LFXI PSOC offered by Cypress
Semiconductor of San Jose, Calif., the design an operation of which are
described within the "CSD User Module" published by Cypress
Semiconductor. For example, via slider assembly 306, the user may slide
their finger in the direction of arrow 314, resulting in the highlighted
portion of the information included within main menu 350 (shown in FIG.
12A) rendered on display assembly 302 scrolling upward. Alternatively,
the user may slide their finger in the direction of arrow 316, resulting
in the highlighted portion of the information included within main menu
350 rendered on display assembly 302 scrolling downward.
[0338] Slider assembly 306 may be configured so that the rate at which
e.g. the highlighted portion of main menu 350 scrolls "upward" or
"downward" varies depending upon the displacement of the finger of the
user with respect to point of origin 320. Therefore, if the user wishes
to quickly scroll "upward", the user may position their finger near the
top of slider assembly 306. Likewise, if the user wishes to quickly
scroll "downward", the user may position their finger near the bottom of
slider assembly 306. Additionally, if the user wishes to slowly scroll
"upward", the user may position their finger slightly "upward" with
respect to point of origin 320 Further, if the user wishes to slowly
scroll "downward", the user may position their finger slightly "downward"
with respect to point of origin 320. Once the appropriate menu item is
highlighted, the user may select the highlighted menu item via one or
more switch assemblies 308, 310.
[0339] Referring also to FIGS. 12B-12F, assume for illustrative purposes
that infusion pump assembly 100, 100' is an insulin pump and the user
wishes to configure infusion pump assembly 100, 100' so that when switch
assembly 318 is depressed by the user, a 0.20 unit bolus dose of insulin
is administered. Accordingly, the user may use slider assembly 306 to
highlight "Bolus" within main menu 350 rendered on display assembly 302.
The user may then use switch assembly 308 to select "Bolus". Once
selected, processing logic (not shown) within remote control assembly 300
may then render submenu 352 on display assembly 302 (as shown in FIG.
12B).
[0340] The user may then use slider assembly 306 to highlight "Manual
Bolus" within submenu 352, which may be selected using switch assembly
308. Processing logic (not shown) within remote control assembly 300 may
then render submenu 354 on display assembly 302 (as shown in FIG. 12C).
[0341] The user may then use slider assembly 306 to highlight "Bolus: 0.0
Units" within submenu 354, which may be selected using switch assembly
308. Processing logic (not shown) within remote control assembly 300 may
then render submenu 356 on display assembly 302 (as shown in FIG. 12D).
[0342] The user may then use slider assembly 306 to adjust the "Bolus"
insulin amount to "0.20 units", which may be selected using switch
assembly 308. Processing logic (not shown) within remote control assembly
300 may then render submenu 358 on display assembly 302 (as shown in FIG.
12E).
[0343] The user 14 may then use slider assembly 306 to highlight
"Confirm", which may be selected using switch assembly 308. Processing
logic (not shown) within remote control assembly 300 may then generate
the appropriate signals that may be sent to the above-described telemetry
circuitry (not shown) included within remote control assembly 300. The
telemetry circuitry (not shown) included within the remote control
assembly may then transmit, via wireless communication channel 312
established between remote control assembly 300 and infusion pump
assembly 100', the appropriate configuration commands to configure
infusion pump assembly 100' so that whenever switch assembly 318 is
depressed by the user, a 0.20 unit bolus dose of insulin is administered.
[0344] Once the appropriate commands are successfully transmitted,
processing logic (not shown) within remote control assembly 300 may once
again render submenu 350 on display assembly 302 (as shown in FIG. 12F).
[0345] Specifically and once programmed via remote control assembly 300,
the user may depress switch assembly 318 of infusion pump assembly 100'
to administer the above-described 0.20 unit bolus dose of insulin. Via
the above-described menuing system included within remote control
assembly 300, the user may define a quantity of insulin to be
administered each time that the user depresses switch assembly 318. While
this particular example specifies that a single depression of switch
assembly 318 is equivalent to 0.20 units of insulin, this is for
illustrative purposes only and is not intended to be a limitation of this
disclosure, as other values (e.g. 1.00 units of insulin per depression)
are equally applicable.
[0346] Assume for illustrative purposes that the user wishes to administer
a 2.00 unit bolus dose of insulin. To activate the above-describe bolus
dose administration system, the user may be required to press and hold
switch assembly 318 for a defined period of time (e.g. five seconds), at
which point infusion pump assembly 100, 100' may generate an audible
signal indicating to the user that infusion pump assembly 100, 100' is
ready to administer a bolus does of insulin via switch assembly 318.
Accordingly, the user may depress switch assembly 318 ten times (i.e.,
2.00 units is ten 0.20 unit doses). After each time that switch assembly
318 is depressed, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' may provide on audible
response to the user via an internal speaker/sound generation device (not
shown). Accordingly, the user may depress switch assembly 318 the first
time and infusion pump assembly 100, 100' may generate a confirmation
beep in response, thus indicating to the user that infusion pump assembly
100, 100' received the command for (in this particular example) 0.20
units of insulin. As the desired bolus dose is 2.00 units of insulin, the
user may repeat this procedure nine more times in order to effectuate a
bolus dose of 2.00 units, wherein infusion pump assembly 100, 100'
generates a confirmation beep after each depression of switch assembly
318.
[0347] While in this particular example, infusion pump assemblies 100,
100' are described as providing one beep after each time the user
depresses switch assembly 318, this is for illustrative purposes only and
is not intended to be a limitation of this disclosure. Specifically,
infusion pump assembly 100, 100' may be configured to provide a single
beep for each defined quantity of insulin. As discussed above, a single
depression of switch assembly 318 may be equivalent to 0.20 units of
insulin. Accordingly, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' may be configured
to provide a single beep for each 0.10 units of insulin. Accordingly, if
infusion pump assembly 100, 100' is configured such that a single
depression of switch assembly 318 is equivalent to 0.20 units of insulin,
each time switch assembly 318 is depressed, infusion pump assembly 100,
100' may provide the user with two beeps (i.e. one for each 0.10 units of
insulin).
[0348] Once the user has depressed switch assembly 318 on infusion pump
assembly 100' a total of ten times, the user may simply wait for infusion
pump assembly 100, 100' to acknowledge receipt of the instructions to
administer a 2.00 unit bolus dose of insulin (as opposed to the
confirmation beep received at each depression of switch assembly 318).
Once a defined period of time (e.g., two seconds) passes, infusion pump
assembly 100, 100' may provide an audible confirmation to the user
concerning the quantity of units to be administered via the bolus insulin
dose that the user just requested. For example, as (in this example)
infusion pump assembly 100, 100' was programmed by the user so that a
single depression of switch assembly 318 is equivalent to 0.20 units of
insulin, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' may beep ten times (i.e., 2.00
units is ten 0.20 unit doses).
[0349] When providing feedback to the user concerning the quantity of
units to be administered via the bolus insulin dose, infusion pump
assembly 100, 100' may provide a multifrequency audible confirmation. For
example and continuing with the above-stated example in which ten beeps
are to be provided to the user, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' may
group the beeps into groups of five (to facilitate easier counting by the
user) and the beeps within each group of five may be rendered by infusion
pump assembly 100, 100' so that each subsequent beep has a higher
frequency than the preceding beep (in a manner similar to a musical
scale). Accordingly and continuing with the above-stated example,
infusion pump assembly 100, 100' may render a 1,000 Hz beep, followed by
an 1,100 Hz beep, followed by a 1,200 Hz beep, followed by a 1,300 Hz
beep, followed by a 1,400 Hz beep (thus completing a group of five
beeps), followed by a short pause, and then a 1,000 Hz beep, followed by
an 1,100 Hz beep, followed by a 1,200 Hz beep, followed by a 1,300 Hz
beep, followed by a 1,400 Hz beep (thus completing the second group of
five beeps). According to various additional/alternative embodiments the
multifrequency audible confirmation may utilize various numbers of tones
incrementing in frequency. For example, an embodiment may utilize twenty
different tones incrementing in frequency. However, the number of tones
should not be construed as a limitation of the present disclosure as
number of tones may vary according to design criteria and user need.
[0350] Once infusion pump assembly 100, 100' completes the rendering of
the multifrequency audible confirmation (i.e. the ten beeps described
above), the user may, within a defined period of time (e.g. two seconds),
depress switch assembly 318 to provide a confirmation signal to infusion
pump assembly 100, 100', indicating that the multifrequency audible
confirmation was accurate and indicative of the size of the bolus dose of
insulin to be administered (i.e. 2.00 units). Upon receiving this
confirmation signal, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' may render a
"confirmation received" audible tone and effectuate the delivery of (in
this particular example) the 2.00 unit bolus dose of insulin. In the
event that infusion pump assembly 100, 100' fails to receive the
above-described confirmation signal, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' may
render a "confirmation failed" audible tone and will not effectuate the
delivery of the bolus dose of insulin. Accordingly, if the multifrequency
audible confirmation was not accurate/indicative of the size of the bolus
dose of insulin to be administered, the user may simply not provide the
above-described confirmation signal, thereby canceling the delivery of
the bolus dose of insulin.
[0351] As discussed above, in one exemplary embodiment of the
above-described infusion pump assembly, infusion pump assembly 100' may
be used to communicate with a remote control assembly 300. When such a
remote control assembly 300 is utilized, infusion pump assembly 100' and
remote control assembly 300 may routinely contact each other to ensure
that the two devices are still in communication with each other. For
example, infusion pump assembly 100' may "ping" remote control assembly
300 to ensure that remote control assembly 300 is present and active.
Further, remote control assembly 300 may "ping" infusion pump assembly
100' to ensure that infusion pump assembly 100' is still present and
active. In the event that one of infusion pump assembly 100' and remote
control assembly 300 fails to establish communication with the other
assembly, the assembly that is unable to establish communication may
sound a "separation" alarm. For example, assume that remote control
assembly 300 is left in the car of the user, while infusion pump assembly
100' is in the pocket of the user. Accordingly and after a defined period
of time, infusion pump assembly 100' may begin sounding the "separation"
alarm, indicating that communication with remote control assembly 300
cannot be established. Using switch assembly 318, the user may
acknowledge/silence this "separation" alarm.
[0352] As the user may define and administer a bolus insulin dose via
switch assembly 318 of infusion pump assembly 100' while remote control
assembly 300 is not in communication with infusion pump assembly 100',
infusion pump assembly 100' may store information concerning the
administered bolus insulin dose within a log file (not shown) stored
within infusion pump assembly 100'. This log file (not shown) may be
stored within nonvolatile memory (not shown) included within infusion
pump assembly 100'. Upon communication being reestablished between
infusion pump assembly 100' and remote control assembly 300, infusion
pump assembly 100' may provide the information concerning the
administered bolus insulin dose stored within the log file (not shown) of
infusion pump assembly 100' to remote control assembly 300.
[0353] Further, if the user anticipates separating remote control assembly
300 from infusion pump assembly 100', the user (via the above-described
menuing system) may configure infusion pump assembly 100' and remote
control assembly 300 to be in "separation" mode, thus eliminating the
occurrence of the above-described "separation" alarms. However, the
devices may continue to "ping" each other so that when they come back
into communication with each other, infusion pump assembly 100' and
remote control assembly 300 may automatically exit "separation" mode.
[0354] Further, if the user anticipates traveling in an airplane, the user
(via the above-described menuing system of remote control assembly 300)
may configure infusion pump assembly 100' and remote control assembly 300
to be in "airplane" mode, in which each of infusion pump assembly 100'
and remote control assembly 300 suspend any and all data transmissions.
While in "airplane" mode, infusion pump assembly 100' and remote control
assembly 300 may or may not continue to receive data.
[0355] Switch assembly 318 may be used to perform additional functions,
such as: checking the battery life of reusable housing assembly 102;
pairing reusable housing assembly 102 with remote control assembly 300;
and aborting the administration of a bolus does of infusible fluid.
[0356] Checking Battery Life:
[0357] Reusable housing assembly 102 may include a rechargeable battery
assembly that may be capable of powering infusion pump assembly 100, 100'
for approximately three days (when fully charged). Such a rechargeable
battery assembly may have a usable life of a predetermined number of
usable hours, for example, or years, or other predetermined length of
usage. However, the predetermined life may depend on many factors,
including but not limited to, one or more of the following: climate,
daily usage, and number of recharges. Whenever reusable housing assembly
102 is disconnected from disposable housing assembly 114, infusion pump
assembly 100, 100' may perform a battery check on the above-described
rechargeable battery assembly whenever switch assembly 318 is depressed
for a defined period of time (e.g. in excess of two seconds). In the
event that the above-described rechargeable battery assembly is
determined to be charged above a desired threshold, infusion pump
assembly 100, 100' may render a "battery pass" tone. Alternatively, in
the event that the above-described rechargeable battery assembly is
determined to be charged below a desired threshold, infusion pump
assembly 100, 100' may render a "battery fail" tone. Infusion pump
assembly 100, 100' may include components and/or circuitry to determine
whether reusable housing assembly 102 is disconnected from disposable
housing assembly 114.
[0358] Pairing:
[0359] As discussed above and in one exemplary embodiment of the
above-described infusion pump assembly, infusion pump assembly 100' may
be used to communicate with remote control assembly 300. In order to
effectuate communication between infusion pump assembly 100' and remote
control assembly 300, a paring process may be performed. During such a
pairing process, one or more infusion pump assemblies (e.g. infusion pump
assembly 100') may be configured to communicate with remote control
assembly 300 and (conversely) remote control assembly 300 may be
configured to communicate with one or more infusion pump assemblies (e.g.
infusion pump assembly 100'). Specifically, the serial numbers of the
infusion pump assemblies (e.g. infusion pump assembly 100') may be
recorded within a pairing file (not shown) included within remote control
assembly 300 and the serial number of remote control assembly 300 may be
recorded within a pairing file (not shown) included within the infusion
pump assemblies (e.g. infusion pump assembly 100').
[0360] According to an embodiment, in order to effectuate such a pairing
procedure, the user may simultaneously hold down one or more switch
assemblies on both remote control assembly 300 and infusion pump assembly
100'. For example, the user may simultaneously hold down switch assembly
310 included within remote control assembly 300 and switch assembly 318
included within infusion pump assembly 100' for a defined period
exceeding e.g. five seconds. Once this defined period is reached, one or
more of remote control assembly 300 and infusion pump assembly 100' may
generate an audible signal indicating that the above-described pairing
procedure has been effectuated.
[0361] According to another embodiment, prior to performing the pairing
process, the user may uncouple reusable housing assembly 102 from
disposable housing assembly 114. By requiring this initial step, further
assurance is provided that an infusion pump assembly being worn by a user
may not be surreptitiously paired with a remote control assembly.
[0362] Once uncoupled, the user may enter pairing mode via input assembly
304 of remote control assembly 300. For example, the user may enter
pairing mode on remote control assembly 300 via the above-described
menuing system in combination with e.g., switch assembly 310. The user
may be prompted on display assembly 302 of remote control assembly 300 to
depress and hold switch assembly 318 on infusion pump assembly 100'.
Additionally, remote control assembly 304 may switch to a low power mode
to e.g., avoid trying to pair with distant infusion pump assemblies. The
user may then depress and hold switch assembly 318 on infusion pump
assembly 100' so that infusion pump assembly 100' enters a receive mode
and waits for a pairing command from remote control assembly 300.
[0363] Remote control assembly 300 may then transmit a pairing request to
infusion pump assembly 100', which may be acknowledged by infusion pump
assembly 100'. Infusion pump assembly 100' may perform a security check
on the pairing request received from remote control assembly 300 and (if
the security check passes) infusion pump assembly 100' may activate a
pump pairing signal (i.e., enter active pairing mode). Remote control
assembly 300 may perform a security check on the acknowledgment received
from infusion pump assembly 100'.
[0364] The acknowledgment received from infusion pump assembly 100' may
define the serial number of infusion pump assembly 100' and remote
control assembly 300 may display that serial number on display assembly
302 of remote control assembly 300. The user may be asked if they wish to
pair with the pump found. If the user declines, the pairing process may
be aborted. If the user agrees to the pairing process, remote control
assembly 300 may prompt the user (via display assembly 302) to depress
and hold switch assembly 318 on infusion pump assembly 100'.
[0365] The user may then depress and hold switch assembly 318 on infusion
pump assembly 100' and depress and hold e.g. switch assembly 310 on
remote control assembly 300.
[0366] Remote control assembly 300 may confirm that remote switch assembly
310 was held (which may be reported to infusion pump assembly 100').
Infusion pump assembly 100' may perform a security check on the
confirmation received from remote control assembly 300 to confirm the
integrity of same. If the integrity of the confirmation received is not
verified, the pairing process is aborted. If the integrity of the
confirmation received is verified, any existing remote pair configuration
file is overwritten to reflect newly-paired remote control assembly 300,
the pump pairing completed signal is activated, and the pairing process
is completed.
[0367] Additionally, infusion pump assembly 100' may confirm that switch
assembly 318 was held (which may be reported to remote control assembly
300). Remote control assembly 300 may perform a security check on the
confirmation received from infusion pump assembly 100' to confirm the
integrity of same. If the integrity of the confirmation received is not
verified, the pairing process is aborted. If the integrity of the
confirmation received is verified, a pair list file within remote control
assembly 300 may be modified to add infusion pump assembly 100'.
Typically, remote control assembly 300 may be capable of pairing with
multiple infusion pump assemblies, while infusion pump assembly 100' may
be capable of only pairing with a single remote control assembly. The
pairing completed signal may be activated and the pairing process may be
completed.
[0368] When the pairing process is completed, one or more of remote
control assembly 300 and infusion pump assembly 100' may generate an
audible signal indicating that the above-described pairing procedure has
been successfully effectuated.
[0369] Aborting Bolus Dose:
[0370] in the event that the user wishes to cancel a bolus dose of e.g.
insulin being administered by infusion pump assembly 100', the user may
depress switch assembly 318 (e.g., shown in FIGS. 1 & 2) for a defined
period exceeding e.g. five seconds. Once this defined period is reached,
infusion pump assembly 100' may render an audible signal indicating that
the above-described cancellation procedure has been effectuated.
[0371] While switch assembly 318 is shown as being positioned on the top
of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', this is for illustrative purposes
only and is not intended to be a limitation of this disclosure, as other
configurations are possible. For example, switch assembly 318 may be
positioned about the periphery of infusion pump assembly 100, 100'.
[0372] Referring also to FIGS. 13-15, there is shown an
alternative-embodiment infusion pump assembly 400. As with pump assembly
100, 100', infusion pump assembly 400 may include reusable housing
assembly 402 and disposable housing assembly 404.
[0373] In a fashion similar to reusable housing assembly 102, reusable
housing assembly 402 may include a mechanical control assembly (that
includes at least one pump assembly and at least one valve assembly).
Reusable housing assembly 402 may also include an electrical control
assembly that is configured to provide control signals to the mechanical
control assembly and effectuate the delivery of an infusible fluid to a
user. The valve assembly may be configured to control the flow of the
infusible fluid through a fluid path and the pump assembly may be
configured to pump the infusible fluid from the fluid path to the user
[0374] In a fashion similar to disposable housing assembly 114, disposable
housing assembly 404 may be configured for a single use or for use for a
specified period of time, e.g., e.g., three days or any other amount of
time. Disposable housing assembly 404 may be configured such that any
components in infusion pump assembly 400 that come in contact with the
infusible fluid are disposed on and/or within disposable housing assembly
404.
[0375] In this particular embodiment of the infusion pump assembly,
infusion pump assembly 400 may include switch assembly 406 positioned
about the periphery of infusion pump assembly 400. For example, switch
assembly 406 may be positioned along a radial edge of infusion pump
assembly 400, which may allow for easier use by a user. Switch assembly
406 may be covered with a waterproof membrane configured to prevent the
infiltration of water into infusion pump assembly 400. Reusable housing
assembly 402 may include main body portion 408 (housing the
above-described mechanical and electrical control assemblies) and locking
ring assembly 410 that may be configured to rotate about main body
portion 408 (in the direction of arrow 412).
[0376] In a fashion similar to reusable housing assembly 102 and
disposable housing assembly 114, reusable housing assembly 402 may be
configured to releasably engage disposable housing assembly 404. Such
releasable engagement may be accomplished by a screw-on, a twist-lock or
a compression fit configuration, for example. In an embodiment in which a
twist-lock configuration is utilized, the user of infusion pump assembly
400 may first properly position reusable housing assembly 402 with
respect to disposable housing assembly 404 and may then rotate locking
ring assembly 410 (in the direction of arrow 412) to releasably engage
reusable housing assembly 402 with disposable housing assembly 404.
[0377] Through the use of locking ring assembly 410, reusable housing
assembly 402 may be properly positioned with respect to disposable
housing assembly 404 and then releasably engaged by rotating locking ring
assembly 410, thus eliminating the need to rotate reusable housing
assembly 402 with respect to disposable housing assembly 404.
Accordingly, reusable housing assembly 402 may be properly aligned with
disposable housing assembly 404 prior to engagement, and such alignment
may not be disturbed during the engagement process. Locking ring assembly
410 may include a latching mechanism (not shown) that may prevent the
rotation of locking ring assembly 410 until reusable housing assembly 402
and disposable housing assembly 404 are properly positioned with respect
to each other.
[0378] Referring also to FIGS. 16-18, there is shown an
alternative-embodiment infusion pump assembly 500. As with pump assembly
100, 100', infusion pump assembly 500 may include reusable housing
assembly 502 and disposable housing assembly 504.
[0379] In a fashion similar to reusable housing assembly 402, reusable
housing assembly 502 may include a mechanical control assembly (that
includes at least one pump assembly and at least one valve assembly).
Reusable housing assembly 502 may also include an electrical control
assembly that is configured to provide control signals to the mechanical
control assembly and effectuate the delivery of an infusible fluid to a
user. The valve assembly may be configured to control the flow of the
infusible fluid through a fluid path and the pump assembly may be
configured to pump the infusible fluid from the fluid path to the user.
[0380] In a fashion similar to disposable housing assembly 404, disposable
housing assembly 504 may be configured for a single use or for use for a
specified period of time, e.g., e.g., three days or any other amount of
time. Disposable housing assembly 504 may be configured such that any
components in infusion pump assembly 500 that come in contact with the
infusible fluid are disposed on and/or within disposable housing assembly
504.
[0381] In this particular embodiment of the infusion pump assembly,
infusion pump assembly 500 may include switch assembly 506 positioned
about the periphery of infusion pump assembly 500. For example, switch
assembly 506 may be positioned along a radial edge of infusion pump
assembly 500, which may allow for easier use by a user. Switch assembly
506 may be covered with a waterproof membrane and/or an o-ring or other
sealing mechanism may be included on the stem 507 of the switch assembly
506 configured to prevent the infiltration of water into infusion pump
assembly 500. However, in some embodiments, switch assembly 506 may
include an overmolded rubber button, thus providing functionality as a
waterproof seal without the use of a waterproof membrane or an o-ring.
However, in still other embodiments, the overmolded rubber button may
additionally be covered by a waterproof membrane and/or include an
o-ring. Reusable housing assembly 502 may include main body portion 508
(housing the above-described mechanical and electrical control
assemblies) and locking ring assembly 510 that may be configured to
rotate about main body portion 508 (in the direction of arrow 512).
[0382] In a fashion similar to reusable housing assembly 402 and
disposable housing assembly 404, reusable housing assembly 502 may be
configured to releasably engage disposable housing assembly 504. Such
releasable engagement may be accomplished by a screw-on, a twist-lock or
a compression fit configuration, for example. In an embodiment in which a
twist-lock configuration is utilized, the user of infusion pump assembly
500 may first properly position reusable housing assembly 502 with
respect to disposable housing assembly 504 and may then rotate locking
ring assembly 510 (in the direction of arrow 512) to releasably engage
reusable housing assembly 502 with disposable housing assembly 404.
[0383] As locking ring assembly 510 included within infusion pump assembly
500 may be taller (i.e., as indicated by arrow 514) than locking ring
assembly 410, locking ring assembly 510 may include a passage 516 through
which button 506 may pass. Accordingly, when assembling reusable housing
assembly 502, locking ring assembly 510 may be installed onto main body
portion 508 (in the direction of arrow 518). Once locking ring assembly
510 is installed onto main body portion 508, one or more locking tabs
(not shown) may prevent locking ring assembly 510 from being removed from
main body portion 508. The portion of switch assembly 506 that protrudes
through passage 516 may then be pressed into main body portion 508 (in
the direction of arrow 520), thus completing the installation of switch
assembly 506.
[0384] Although button 506 is shown in various locations on infusion pump
assembly 500, button 506, in other embodiments, may be located anywhere
desirable on infusion pump assembly 500.
[0385] Through the use of locking ring assembly 510, reusable housing
assembly 502 may be properly positioned with respect to disposable
housing assembly 504 and then releasably engaged by rotating locking ring
assembly 510, thus eliminating the need to rotate reusable housing
assembly 502 with respect to disposable housing assembly 504.
Accordingly, reusable housing assembly 502 may be properly aligned with
disposable housing assembly 504 prior to engagement, and such alignment
may not be disturbed during the engagement process. Locking ring assembly
510 may include a latching mechanism (not shown) that prevents the
rotation of locking ring assembly 510 until reusable housing assembly 502
and disposable housing assembly 504 are properly positioned with respect
to each other. Passage 516 may be elongated to allow for the movement of
locking ring 510 about switch assembly 506.
[0386] Referring also to FIGS. 19A-19B & 20-21, there are shown various
views of infusion pump assembly 500, which is shown to include reusable
housing assembly 502, switch assembly 506, and main body portion 508. As
discussed above, main body portion 508 may include a plurality of
components, examples of which may include but are not limited to volume
sensor assembly 148, printed circuit board 600, vibration motor assembly
602, shape memory actuator anchor 604, switch assembly 506, battery 606,
antenna assembly 608, pump assembly 106, measurement valve assembly 610,
volume sensor valve assembly 612 and reservoir valve assembly 614. To
enhance clarity, printed circuit board 600 has been removed from FIG. 19B
to allow for viewing of the various components positioned beneath printed
circuit board 600.
[0387] The various electrical components that may be electrically coupled
with printed circuit board 600 may utilize spring-biased terminals that
allow for electrical coupling without the need for soldering the
connections. For example, vibration motor assembly 602 may utilize a pair
of spring-biased terminals (one positive terminal and one negative
terminal) that are configured to press against corresponding conductive
pads on printed circuit board 600 when vibration motor assembly 602 is
positioned on printed circuit board 600. However, in the exemplary
embodiment, vibration motor assembly 602 is soldered directly to the
printed circuit board.
[0388] As discussed above, volume sensor assembly 148 may be configured to
monitor the amount of fluid infused by infusion pump assembly 500. For
example, volume sensor assembly 148 may employ acoustic volume sensing,
which is the subject of U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,575,310 and 5,755,683 assigned
to DEKA Products Limited Partnership, as well as the U.S. patent
application Publication Nos. US 2007/0228071 A1, US 2007/0219496 A1, US
2007/0219480 A1, US 2007/0219597 A1, the entire disclosures of all of
which are incorporated herein by reference.
[0389] Vibration motor assembly 602 may be configured to provide a
vibration-based signal to the user of infusion pump assembly 500. For
example, in the event that the voltage of battery 606 (which powers
infusion pump assembly 500) is below the minimum acceptable voltage,
vibration motor assembly 602 may vibrate infusion pump assembly 500 to
provide a vibration-based signal to the user of infusion pump assembly
500. Shape memory actuator anchor 604 may provide a mounting point for
the above-described shape memory actuator (e.g. shape memory actuator
112). As discussed above, shape memory actuator 112 may be, for example,
a conductive shape-memory alloy wire that changes shape with temperature.
The temperature of shape-memory actuator 112 may be changed with a
heater, or more conveniently, by application of electrical energy.
Accordingly, one end of shape memory actuator 112 may be rigidly affixed
(i.e., anchored) to shape memory actuator anchor 604 and the other end of
shape memory actuator 112 may be applied to e.g. a valve assembly and/or
a pump actuator. Therefore, by applying electrical energy to shape memory
actuator 112, the length of shape memory actuator 112 may be controlled
and, therefore, the valve assembly and/or the pump actuator to which it
is attached may be manipulated.
[0390] Antenna assembly 608 may be configured to allow for wireless
communication between e.g. infusion pump assembly 500 and remote control
assembly 300 (FIG. 11). As discussed above, remote control assembly 300
may allow the user to program infusion pump assembly 500 and e.g.
configure bolus infusion events. As discussed above, infusion pump
assembly 500 may include one or more valve assemblies configured to
control the flow of the infusible fluid through a fluid path (within
infusion pump assembly 500) and pump assembly 106 may be configured to
pump the infusible fluid from the fluid path to the user. In this
particular embodiment of infusion pump assembly 500, infusion pump
assembly 500 is shown to include three valve assemblies, namely
measurement valve assembly 610, volume sensor valve assembly 612, and
reservoir valve assembly 614.
[0391] As discussed above and referring also to FIG. 21, the infusible
fluid may be stored within reservoir 118. In order to effectuate the
delivery of the infusible fluid to the user, the processing logic (not
shown) included within infusion pump assembly 500 may energize shape
memory actuator 112, which may be anchored on one end using shape memory
actuator anchor 604. Referring also to FIG. 22A, shape memory actuator
112 may result in the activation of pump assembly 106 and reservoir valve
assembly 614. Reservoir valve assembly 614 may include reservoir valve
actuator 614A and reservoir valve 614B, and the activation of reservoir
valve assembly 614 may result in the downward displacement of reservoir
valve actuator 614A and the closing of reservoir valve 614B, resulting in
the effective isolation of reservoir 118. Further, pump assembly 106 may
include pump plunger 106A and pump chamber 106B and the activation of
pump assembly 106 may result in pump plunger 106A being displaced in a
downward fashion into pump chamber 106B and the displacement of the
infusible fluid (in the direction of arrow 616).
[0392] Volume sensor valve assembly 612 may include volume sensor valve
actuator 612A and volume sensor valve 612B. Referring also to FIG. 22B,
volume sensor valve actuator 612A may be closed via a spring assembly
that provides mechanical force to seal volume sensor valve 612B. However,
when pump assembly 106 is activated, if the displaced infusible fluid is
of sufficient pressure to overcome the mechanical sealing force of volume
sensor valve assembly 612, the displacement of the infusible fluid occurs
in the direction of arrow 618. This may result in the filling of volume
sensor chamber 620 included within volume sensor assembly 148. Through
the use of speaker assembly 622, port assembly 624, reference microphone
626, spring diaphragm 628, invariable volume microphone 630, volume
sensor assembly 148 may determine the volume of infusible fluid included
within volume sensor chamber 620.
[0393] Referring also to FIG. 22C, once the volume of infusible fluid
included within volume sensor chamber 620 is calculated, shape memory
actuator 632 may be energized, resulting in the activation of measurement
valve assembly 610, which may include measurement valve actuator 610A and
measurement valve 610B. Once activated and due to the mechanical energy
asserted on the infusible fluid within volume sensor chamber 620 by
spring diaphragm 628, the infusible fluid within volume sensor chamber
620 may be displaced (in the direction of arrow 634) through disposable
cannula 138 and into the body of the user.
[0394] Referring also to FIG. 23, there is shown an exploded view of
infusion pump assembly 500. Shape memory actuator 632 may be anchored (on
a first end) to shape memory actuator anchor 636. Additionally, the other
end of shape memory actuator 632 may be used to provide mechanical energy
to valve assembly 638, which may activate measurement valve assembly 610.
Volume sensor assembly spring retainer 642 may properly position volume
sensor assembly 148 with respect to the various other components of
infusion pump assembly 500. Valve assembly 638 may be used in conjunction
with shape memory actuator 112 to activate pump plunger 106A. Measurement
valve 610B, volume sensor valve 612B and/or reservoir valve 614B may be
self-contained valves that are configured to allow for installation
during assembly of infusion pump assembly 500 by pressing the valves
upward into the lower surface of main body portion 508.
[0395] Referring also to FIG. 24 & FIGS. 25A-25D, there is shown a
more-detailed view of pump assembly 106. Pump actuator assembly 644 may
include pump actuator support structure 646, bias spring 648, and lever
assembly 650.
[0396] Referring also to FIGS. 26A-26B & FIGS. 27A-27B, there is shown a
more-detailed view of measurement valve assembly 610. As discussed above,
valve assembly 638 may activate measurement valve assembly 610.
[0397] Referring also to FIGS. 28A-28D, infusion pump assembly 500 may
include measurement valve assembly 610. As discussed above, valve
assembly 638 may be activated via shape memory actuator 632 and actuator
assembly 640. Accordingly, to infuse the quantity of infusible fluid
stored within volume sensor chamber 620, shape memory actuator 632 may
need to activate valve assembly 638 for a considerable period of time
(e.g. one minute or more). As this would consume a considerable amount of
power from battery 606, measurement valve assembly 610 may allow for the
temporary activation of valve assembly 638, at which point measurement
valve latch 656 may prevent valve assembly 638 from returning to its
non-activated position. Shape memory actuator 652 may be anchored on a
first end using electrical contact 654. The other end of shape memory
actuator 652 may be connected to a valve latch 656. When shape memory
actuator 652 is activated, shape memory actuator 652 may pull valve latch
656 forward and release valve assembly 638. As such, measurement valve
assembly 610 may be activated via shape memory actuator 632. Once
measurement valve assembly 610 has been activated, valve latch 656 may
automatically latch valve assembly 638 in the activated position.
Actuating shape memory actuator 652 may pull valve latch 656 forward and
release valve assembly 638. Assuming shape memory actuator 632 is no
longer activated, measurement valve assembly 610 may move to a
de-activated state once valve latch 656 has released valve assembly 638.
Accordingly, through the use of measurement valve assembly 610, shape
memory actuator 632 does not need to be activated during the entire time
that it takes to infuse the quantity of infusible fluid stored within
volume sensor chamber 620.
[0398] As discussed above, the above-described infusion pump assemblies
(e.g., infusion pumps assemblies 100, 100', 400, 500) may include an
external infusion set 134 configured to deliver the infusible fluid to a
user. External infusion set 134 may include a cannula assembly 136, which
may include a needle or a disposable cannula 138, and tubing assembly
140. Tubing assembly 140 may be in fluid communication with reservoir
118, for example, by way of the fluid path, and with cannula assembly 138
for example, either directly or by way of a cannula interface 142.
[0399] Referring also to FIG. 29, there is shown an alternative embodiment
infusion pump assembly 700 that is configured to store a portion of
tubing assembly 140. Specifically, infusion pump assembly 700 may include
peripheral tubing storage assembly 702 that is configured to allow the
user to wind a portion of tubing assembly 140 about the periphery of
infusion pump assembly 700 (in a manner similar to that of a yoyo).
Peripheral tubing storage assembly 702 may be positioned about the
periphery of infusion pump assembly 700. Peripheral tubing storage
assembly 702 may be configured as an open trough into which a portion of
tubing assembly 140 may be wound. Alternatively, peripheral tubing
storage assembly 702 may include one or more divider portions 704, 706
that form a plurality of narrower troughs that may be sized to generate
an interference fit between the walls of the narrower trough and the
exterior surface of the portion of tubing 140. When peripheral tubing
storage assembly 705 includes plurality of divider portions 704, 706, the
resulting narrower troughs may be wound in a spiral fashion about the
periphery of infusion pump assembly 700 (in a manner similar to the
thread of a screw).
[0400] Referring also to FIGS. 30-31, there is shown an alternative
embodiment infusion pump assembly 750 that is configured to store a
portion of tubing assembly 140. Specifically, infusion pump assembly 750
may include peripheral tubing storage assembly 752 that is configured to
allow the user to wind a portion of tubing assembly 140 about the
periphery of infusion pump assembly 750 (again, in a manner similar to
that of a yoyo). Peripheral tubing storage assembly 752 may be positioned
about the periphery of infusion pump assembly 750. Peripheral tubing
storage assembly 752 may be configured as an open trough into which a
portion of tubing assembly 140 is wound. Alternatively, peripheral tubing
storage assembly 752 may include one or more divider portions 754, 756
that form a plurality of narrower troughs that may be sized to generate
an interference fit between the walls of the narrower trough and the
exterior surface of the portion of tubing 140. When peripheral tubing
storage assembly 752 includes plurality of divider portions 754, 756, the
resulting narrower trough may be wound in a spiral fashion about the
periphery of infusion pump assembly 750 (again, in a manner similar to
the thread of a screw).
[0401] Infusion pump assembly 750 may include tubing retainer assembly
758. Tubing retainer assembly 758 may be configured to releasably secure
tubing assembly 140 so as to prevent tubing assembly 140 from unraveling
from around infusion pump assembly 750. In one embodiment of tubing
retainer assembly 758, tubing retainer assembly 758 may include downward
facing pin assembly 760 positioned above upward facing pin assembly 762.
The combination of pin assemblies 760, 762 may define a "pinch point"
through which tubing assembly 140 may be pushed. Accordingly, the user
may wrap tubing assembly 140 around the periphery of infusion pump
assembly 750, wherein each loop of tubing assembly 140 is secured within
peripheral tubing storage assembly 752 via tubing retainer assembly 758.
In the event that the user wishes to lengthen the unsecured portion of
tubing assembly 140, the user may release one loop of tubing assembly 140
from tubing retainer assembly 758. Conversely, in the event that the user
wishes to shorten the unsecured portion of tubing assembly 140, the user
may secure one additional loop of tubing assembly 140 within tubing
retainer assembly 758.
[0402] Referring also to FIGS. 32-33, there is shown an exemplary
embodiment of infusion pump assembly 800. As with infusion pump
assemblies 100, 100', 400, and 500, infusion pump assembly 800 may
include reusable housing assembly 802 and disposable housing assembly
804.
[0403] With reference also to FIGS. 34A-34B, in a fashion similar to
infusion pump assembly 100, reusable housing assembly 802 may be
configured to releasably engage disposable housing assembly 804. Such
releasable engagement may be effectuated by a screw-on, twist-lock, or
compression fit configuration, for example. Infusion pump assembly 800
may include locking ring assembly 806. For example, reusable housing
assembly 802 may be properly positioned relative to disposable housing
assembly, and locking ring assembly 806 may be rotated to releasable
engage reusable housing assembly 802 and disposable housing assembly 804.
[0404] Locking ring assembly 806 may include nub 808 that may facilitate
rotation of locking ring assembly 806. Additionally, the position of nub
808, e.g., relative to tab 810 of disposable housing assembly 804, may
provide verification that reusable housing assembly 802 is fully engaged
with disposable housing assembly 804. For example, as shown in FIG. 34A,
when reusable housing assembly 802 is properly aligned with disposable
housing assembly 804, nub 808 may be aligned in a first position relative
to tab 810. Upon achieving a fully engaged condition, by rotation locking
ring assembly 806, nub 808 may be aligned in a second position relative
to tab 810, as shown in FIG. 34B.
[0405] Referring also to FIGS. 35A-35C and FIGS. 36-38A, in a fashion
similar to reusable housing assembly 102, reusable housing assembly 802
may include mechanical control assembly 812 (e.g., which may include
valve assembly 814, shown in FIG. 36, including one or more valves and
one or more pumps for pumping and controlling the flow of the infusible
fluid). Reusable housing assembly 802 may also include an electrical
control assembly 816 that may be configured to provide control signals to
the mechanical control assembly 812 to effectuate the delivery of an
infusible fluid to the user. Valve assembly 814 may be configured to
control the flow of the infusible fluid through a fluid path and the pump
assembly may be configured to pump the infusible fluid from the fluid
path to the user.
[0406] Mechanical control assembly 812 and electrical control assembly 816
may be contained within a housing defined by base plate 818, body 820. In
some embodiments one or more of base plate 818 and body 820 may provide
electromagnetic shielding. In such an embodiment, the electromagnetic
shielding may prevent and/or reduce electromagnetic interference received
by electrical control assembly 816 and/or created by electrical control
assembly 816. Additionally/alternatively, EMI shield 822 may be included,
as shown in FIG. 36 and FIG. 37. EMI shield 822 may provide shielding
against generated and/or received electromagnetic interference.
[0407] Reusable housing assembly 802 may include a switch assembly that
may be configured to receive user commands (e.g., for bolus delivery,
pairing with a remote control assembly, or the like). The switch assembly
may include button 824 that may be disposed in opening 826 of body 820.
As shown, e.g., in FIG. 35B, locking ring assembly 806 may include radial
slot 828 that may be configured to allow locking ring assembly 806 to be
rotated relative to body 820 while still providing facile access to
button 824.
[0408] Referring also to FIGS. 39A-39C, electrical control assembly 816
may include printed circuit board 830 as well as battery 832. Printed
circuit board 830 may include the various control electronics for
monitoring and controlling the amount of infusible fluid that has been
and/or is being pumped. For example, electrical control assembly 816 may
measure the amount of infusible fluid that has just been dispensed, and
determine, based upon the dosage required by the user, whether enough
infusible fluid has been dispensed. If not enough infusible fluid has
been dispensed, electrical control assembly 816 may determine that more
infusible fluid should be pumped. Electrical control assembly 816 may
provide the appropriate signal to mechanical control assembly 812 so that
any additional necessary dosage may be pumped or electrical control
assembly 816 may provide the appropriate signal to mechanical control
assembly 812 so that the additional dosage may be dispensed with the next
dosage. Alternatively, if too much infusible fluid has been dispensed,
electrical control assembly 816 may provide the appropriate signal to
mechanical control assembly 812 so that less infusible fluid may be
dispensed in the next dosage. Electrical control assembly 816 may include
one or more microprocessors. In an exemplary embodiment, electrical
control assembly 816 may include three microprocessors. One processor
(e.g., which may include, but is not limited to a CC2510
microcontroller/RF transceiver, available from Chipcon AS, of Oslo,
Norway) may be dedicated to radio communication, e.g., for communicating
with a remote control assembly. Two additional microprocessors (example
of which may include, but is not limited to an MSP430 microcontroller,
available from Texas Instruments Inc. of Dallas, Tex.) may be dedicated
to issuing and carrying out commands (e.g., to dispense a dosage of
infusible fluid, process feedback signals from a volume measurement
device, and the like).
[0409] As shown in FIG. 35C, base plate 818 may provide access to
electrical contacts 834, e.g., which may be electrically coupled to
electrical control assembly 816 for recharging battery 832. Base plate
818 may include one or more features (e.g., openings 836, 838) which may
be configured to facilitate proper alignment with disposable housing
assembly 804 by way of cooperating features (e.g., tabs) of disposable
housing assembly 804. Additionally, as shown in FIGS. 40A-40C, 41A-41B,
and 42A-42C, base plate 818 may include various features for mounting
valve assembly 814 and electrical control assembly 816, as well as
providing access to disposable housing assembly 804 by valve assembly
814.
[0410] Locking ring assembly 806 may include grip inserts 840, 842, e.g.,
which may include an elastomeric or textured material that may facilitate
gripping and twisting locking ring assembly 806, e.g., for
engaging/disengaging reusable housing assembly 802 and disposable housing
assembly 804. Additionally, locking ring assembly 806 may include a
sensing component (e.g., magnet 844) that may interact with a component
of reusable housing assembly 802 (e.g., a Hall Effect sensor), e.g., to
provide an indication of the nature of a mating component (e.g., which in
some embodiments may include, but is not limited to, one or more of
disposable housing assembly 804, a charging station, or a filling
station) and/or of whether reusable housing assembly 802 is properly
engaged with the mating component. In the exemplary embodiment, a Hall
Effect sensor (not shown) may be located on the pump printed circuit
board. The Hall Effect sensor may detect when the locking ring has been
rotated to a closed position. Thus, the Hall Effect sensor together with
magnet 844 may provide a system for determining whether the locking ring
has been rotated to a closed position.
[0411] The sensing component (magnet) 844 together with the reusable
housing assembly components, i.e., in the exemplary embodiment, the Hall
Effect sensor, may work to provide for a determination of whether the
reusable housing assembly is properly attached to the intended component
or device. Locking ring assembly 806 may not turn without being attached
to a component, i.e., disposable housing assembly 804, a dust cover or a
charger. Thus, the sensing component together with the reusable housing
assembly component may function to provide many advantageous safety
features to the infusion pump system. These features may include, but are
not limited to, one or more of the following. Where the system does not
detect being attached to a disposable assembly, a dust cover or a
charger, the system may notify, alert or alarm the user as the reusable
portion, e.g., the valves and pumping components, may be vulnerable to
contamination or destruction which may compromise the integrity of the
reusable assembly. Thus, the system may provide for an integrity alarm to
alert the user of potential reusable integrity threats. Also, where the
system senses the reusable assembly is attached to a dust cover, the
system may power off or reduce power to conserve power. This may provide
for more efficient use of power where the reusable assembly is not
connecting to a component in which it needs to interact.
[0412] Reusable housing assembly 802 may attach to a number of different
components, including but not limited to, a disposable housing assembly,
a dust cover or a battery charger/battery charging station. In each case,
the Hall Effect sensor may detect that the locking ring is in the closed
position, and therefore, that reusable housing assembly 802 is releasably
engaged to a disposable housing assembly, a dust cover, or a battery
charger/battery charging station (or, another component). The infusion
pump system may determine the component to which it is attached by using
the AVS system described in more detail below or by an electronic
contact. Referring now also to FIGS. 38B-38D, one embodiment of a dust
cover (e.g., dust cover 839) is shown. In the exemplary embodiment, dust
cover 839 may include features 841, 843, 845, 847 such that the locking
ring of reusable housing assembly 802 may releasably engage dust cover
839. In addition, dust cover 839 may further include recess region 849
for accommodating the valving and pumping features of reusable housing
assembly 804. For example, with respect to the dust cover, the AVS system
may determine that a dust cover, and not a disposable housing assembly,
is connected to the reusable housing assembly. The AVS system may
distinguish using a look-up table or other comparative data and comparing
the measurement data with characteristic dust cover or empty disposable
housing assembly data. With respect to the battery charger, the battery
charger, in the exemplary embodiments, may include electric contacts.
When the reusable housing assembly is attached to the battery charger,
the infusion pump assembly electronic system may sense that the contacts
have been made, and will thus indicate that the reusable housing assembly
is attached to a battery charger.
[0413] Referring also to FIGS. 43A-45B and FIGS. 44A-44C an embodiment of
valve assembly 814, which may include one or more valves and one or more
pumps, is shown. As with infusion pump assemblies 100, 100', 400, and
500, valve assembly 814 may generally include reservoir valve 850,
plunger pump 852, volume sensor valve 854, and measurement valve 856.
Similar to the previous description, reservoir valve 850 and plunger pump
852 may be actuated by shape memory actuator 858, which may be anchored
(on a first end) to shape memory actuator anchor 860. Additionally,
measurement valve 856 may be actuated, via valve actuator 862, by shape
memory actuator 864, which may be anchored (on a first end) to shape
memory actuator anchor 866. In a similar manner as discussed above,
measurement valve may be maintained in an open position via measurement
valve latch assembly 868. Measurement valve 856 may be released via
actuation of shape memory actuator 870, which may be anchored (on a first
end) by shape memory actuator anchor 872. In some embodiments, shape
memory actuator anchor 860 may be potted onto the reusable housing
assembly. Using this process during manufacture ensures shape memory
length actuator 858 is installed and maintains the desired length and
tension/strain.
[0414] Referring also to FIGS. 45A-45B and FIGS. 46A-46E, shape memory
actuator 858 (e.g., which may include one or more shape memory wires) may
actuate plunger pump 852 via actuator assembly 874. Actuator assembly 874
may include bias spring 876 and lever assembly 878. Actuator assembly 874
may actuate both plunger pump 852 and measurement valve 850.
[0415] Referring also to FIGS. 47A-47B, measurement valve 856 may be
actuated by shape memory actuator 864, via valve actuator 862 and lever
assembly 878. Once actuated, measurement valve latch assembly 868 may
maintain measurement valve 856 in an open position. Measurement valve
latch assembly 868 actuated by shape memory actuator 870 to release
measurement valve 856, allowing it to return to a closed position.
[0416] Disposable housing assembly 804 may be configured for a single use
or for use for a specified period of time, e.g., e.g., three days or any
other amount of time. Disposable housing assembly 804 may be configured
such that any of the component of infusion pump assembly 800 that come in
contact with the infusible fluid may be disposed on and/or within
disposable housing assembly 804. As such, the risk of contaminating the
infusible fluid may be reduced.
[0417] Referring also to FIG. 48 and FIGS. 49A-49C, disposable housing
assembly 804 may include base portion 900, membrane assembly 902, and top
portion 904. Base portion 900 may include recess 906 that together with
membrane assembly 902 defines reservoir 908 for receiving an infusible
fluid (not shown), e.g., insulin. Referring also to FIGS. 50A-50C, recess
906 may be at least partially formed by and integral with base portion
900. Membrane assembly 902 may be sealingly engaged with base portion
900, e.g., by being compressively pinched between base portion 900 and
top portion 904. Top portion 904 may be attached to base portion 900 by
conventional means, such as gluing, heat sealing, ultrasonic welding, and
compression fitting. Additionally/alternatively, membrane assembly 902
may be attached to base portion 900, e.g., via gluing, ultrasonic
welding, heat sealing, and the like, to provide a seal between membrane
assembly 902 and base portion 900.
[0418] Still referring to FIGS. 48 and 50A, recess 906, in the exemplary
embodiment, includes raised portion 901 which includes area 903 about
fluid openings 905 leading to the fluid line. Raised portion 901, in the
exemplary embodiment, extends about the perimeter of recess 906. However,
in other embodiments, raised portion 901 may not extend the entire
perimeter, but may be partially about the perimeter. Area 903 about fluid
openings 905 may be shaped as shown in the exemplary embodiment,
including an angled portion, which in some embodiments, includes 45
degree angles, however in other embodiments, the angle may be greater or
lesser. In some embodiments, the pump may not generate a sufficient
enough vacuum to collapse the reservoir so as to eliminate the entire
volume of fluid that may be stored in the reservoir. Raised portion 901
may act to minimize wasted fluid.
[0419] Fluid openings 905, which, in the exemplary embodiment, may include
three openings, however, in other embodiments may include more openings
or fewer openings, may be surrounded by area 903 of the raised portion.
In the exemplary embodiment, fluid openings 905 may be narrow in the
center, thus creating a surface tension that may prevent the air from
being drawn into the opening. In the exemplary embodiment, this area may
be designed to encourage any air that is present in the reservoir to be
drawn above one of fluid openings 905 rather than be pulled through fluid
openings 905 and into the fluid line. Additionally, because there may be
more than one fluid opening 905, where an air bubble is caught above one,
the air may not prevent fluid from flowing through the other two
openings.
[0420] Referring also to FIGS. 51A-51C, disposable housing assembly 804
may also include fluid pathway cover 910. Fluid pathway cover 910 may be
received in cavity 912 formed on/within base portion 900. Fluid pathway
cover 910 may, in some embodiments, include at least a portion of one or
more channels (e.g., channel 914). The channels included in fluid pathway
cover 910 may fluidly couple one or more volcano valve features (e.g.
volcano valves 916) included on base portion 900. Volcano valves 916 may
include a protrusion having an opening extending through it.
Additionally, fluid pathway cover 910 and base portion 900 may each
define a portion of recess (e.g., recess portions 918, 920 included in
base portion 900 and fluid pathway cover 910 respectively) for fluidly
coupling to an infusion set (e.g., including cannula 922). Cannula 922
may be coupled to disposable housing assembly 804 by conventional means
(e.g., gluing, heat sealing, compression fit, or the like). The fluid
pathways defined by fluid pathway cover 910 and the volcano valves (e.g.,
volcano valves 916) of base portion 900 may define a fluid pathway
between reservoir 908 and cannula 922 for the delivery of the infusible
fluid to the user via the infusion set. However, in some embodiments,
fluid path cover 910 may include at least a portion of the fluid path,
and in some embodiments, fluid path cover 910 may not include at least a
portion of the fluid path. In the exemplary embodiment, fluid pathway
cover 910 may be laser welded to base portion 900. However, in other
embodiments, fluid pathway cover 910 may also be connected to base
portion 900 by conventional means (e.g., gluing, heat sealing, ultrasonic
welding, compression fit, or the like) to achieve a generally fluid tight
seal between fluid pathway cover 910 and base portion 900.
[0421] With reference also to FIGS. 54A-54C, disposable housing assembly
804 may further include valve membrane cover 924. Valve membrane cover
924 may be at least partially disposed over the volcano valves (e.g.,
volcano valve 916) and pumping recess 926 included on/within base portion
900. Valve membrane cover 924 may include a flexible material, e.g.,
which may be selectively engaged against the volcano valves by reservoir
valve 850, volume sensor valve 854, and measurement valve 856 of reusable
housing assembly 802, e.g., for controlling the flow of the infusible
fluid. Additionally, valve membrane cover 924 may be resiliently deformed
into pumping recess 926 by plunger pump 852 to effectuate pumping of the
infusible fluid. Valve membrane cover 924 may be engaged between base
portion 900 and top portion 904 of disposable housing assembly 804 to
form seal 928 between valve membrane cover 924 and base portion 900. For
example, in the exemplary embodiment, valve membrane cover 924 may be
overmolded onto base portion 900. In other embodiment, valve membrane
cover 924 may be compressively pinched between base portion 900 and top
portion 904 to form seal 928. Additionally/alternatively, valve membrane
insert may be connected to one or more of base portion 900 and top
portion 904, e.g., by gluing, heat sealing, or the like.
[0422] Referring also to FIGS. 53A-C, top portion 904 may include
alignment tabs 930, 932 that may be configured to be at least partially
received in openings 836, 838 of base plate 818 of reusable housing
assembly 802 to ensure proper alignment between reusable housing assembly
802 and disposable housing assembly 804. Additionally, top portion 904
may include one or more radial tabs 934, 936, 938, 940 configured to be
engaged by cooperating tabs 942, 944, 946, 948 of locking ring assembly
806. The one or more radial tabs (e.g., radial tab 940) may include stops
(e.g., alignment tab stop 950, which may be used for welding, it's the
tab that fits in the recess to locate and ultrasonically weld), e.g.,
which may prevent further rotation of locking ring assembly 806 once
reusable housing assembly 802 and disposable housing assembly 804 are
fully engaged.
[0423] As discussed above, valve membrane insert 924 may allow for pumping
and flow of the infusible fluid by reservoir valve 850, plunger pump 852,
volume sensor valve 854, and measurement valve 856. Accordingly, top
portion 904 may include one or more openings (e.g., openings 952, 954,
956) that may expose at least a portion of valve membrane insert 924 for
actuation by reservoir valve 850, plunger pump 852, volume sensor valve
854, and measurement valve 856. Additionally, top portion 904 may include
one or more openings 958, 960, 962 which may be configured to allow the
fill volume to be controlled during filling of reservoir 908, as will be
discussed in greater detail below. Reservoir assembly 902 may include
ribs 964, 966, 968 (e.g., as shown in FIG. 52A), which may be at least
partially received in respective openings 958, 960, 962. As will be
described in greater detail below, a force may be applied to one or more
of ribs 964, 966, 968 to, at least temporarily, reduce the volume of
reservoir 908.
[0424] In some embodiments, it may be desirable to provide a seal between
reusable housing assembly 802 and disposable housing assembly 804.
Accordingly, disposable housing assembly 804 may include sealing assembly
970. Sealing assembly 970 may include, for example, an elastomeric member
that may provide a compressible rubber or plastic layer between reusable
housing assembly 802 and disposable housing assembly 804 when engaged,
thus preventing inadvertent disengagement and penetration by outside
fluids. For example, sealing assembly 970 may be a watertight seal
assembly and, thus, enable a user to wear infusion pump assembly 800
while swimming, bathing or exercising.
[0425] In a fashion similar to, e.g., disposable housing assembly 114,
disposable housing assembly 802 may, in some embodiments, be configured
to have reservoir 908 filled a plurality of times. However, in some
embodiments, disposable housing assembly 114 may be configured such that
reservoir 908 may not be refilled. Referring also to FIGS. 57-64, fill
adapter 1000 may be configured to be coupled to disposable housing
assembly 804 for refilling reservoir 908 using a syringe (not shown).
Fill adapter 1000 may include locking tabs 1002, 1004, 1006, 1008 that
may be configured to engage radial tabs 934, 936, 938, 940 of disposable
housing assembly 804 in a manner generally similar to tabs 942, 944, 946,
948 of locking ring assembly 806. Accordingly, fill adapter 1000 may be
releasably engaged with disposable housing assembly 804 by aligning fill
adapter 1000 with disposable housing assembly 804 and rotating fill
adapter 1000 and disposable housing assembly 804 relative to one another
to releasably engage locking tabs 1002, 1004, 1006, 1008 with radial tabs
934, 936, 938, 940.
[0426] Fill adapter 1000 may further include filling aid 1010, which may
include guide passage 1012, e.g., which may be configured to guide a
needle of a syringe (not shown) to a septum of disposable housing
assembly 804 to allow reservoir 908 of disposable housing assembly 804 to
be filled by the syringe. In some embodiments, guide passage 1012 may be
an angled bevel or other gradual angled bevel to further guide a syringe
to a septum. Fill adapter 1000 may facilitate filling reservoir 908 by
providing a relatively large insertion area, e.g., at the distal opening
of guide passage 1012. Guide passage 1012 may generally taper to a
smaller proximal opening that may be properly aligned with the septum of
disposable housing assembly 804, when fill adapter 1000 is engaged with
disposable housing assembly 804. Accordingly, fill adapter 1000 may
reduce the dexterity and aim necessary to properly insert a needle
through the septum of disposable housing assembly 804 for the purpose of
filling reservoir 908.
[0427] As discussed above, disposable housing assembly 804 may configured
to facilitate controlling the quantity of infusible fluid delivered to
reservoir 908 during filling. For example, membrane assembly 902 of
disposable housing assembly 804 may include ribs 964, 966, 968 that may
be depressed and at least partially displaced into reservoir 908, thereby
reducing the volume of reservoir 908. Accordingly, when infusible fluid
is delivered to reservoir 908, the volume of fluid that may be
accommodated by reservoir 908 may be correspondingly reduced. Ribs 964,
966, 968 may be accessible via openings 958, 960, 962 in top portion 904
of disposable housing assembly 804.
[0428] Fill adapter 1000 may include one or more button assemblies (e.g.,
button assemblies 1014, 1016, 1018) corresponding to ribs 964, 966, 968.
That is, when fill adapter 1000 is releasably engaged with disposable
housing assembly 804, buttons 1014, 1016, 1018 may be aligned with ribs
964, 966, 968. Button assemblies 1014, 1016, 1018 may be, for example,
cantilever members capable of being depressed. When fill adapter 1000 is
releasably engaged with disposable housing assembly 804, one or more of
button assemblies 1014, 1016, 1018 may be depressed, and may
correspondingly displace a respective one of ribs 964, 966, 698 into
reservoir 908, causing an attendant reduction in the volume of reservoir
908.
[0429] For example, assume for illustrative purposes that reservoir 908
has a maximum capacity of 3.00 mL. Further, assume that button assembly
1014 is configured to displace rib 964 into disposable housing assembly
804, resulting in a 0.5 mL reduction in the 3.00 mL capacity of
disposable housing assembly 804. Further, assume that button assembly
1016 is configured to displace rib 966 into disposable housing assembly
804, also resulting in a 0.5 mL reduction in the 3.00 mL capacity of
disposable housing assembly 804. Further, assume that button assembly
1018 is configured to displace slot assembly 968 into disposable housing
assembly 804, also resulting in a 0.5 mL reduction in the 3.00 mL
capacity of disposable housing assembly 804. Therefore, if the user
wishes to fill reservoir 908 within disposable housing assembly 804 with
2.00 mL of infusible fluid, in some embodiments, the user may first fill
the reservoir to the 3.00 mL capacity and then depresses button
assemblies 1016 and 1014 (resulting in the displacement of rib 966 into
disposable housing assembly 804), effectively reducing the 3.00 mL
capacity of reservoir 908 within disposable housing assembly 804 to 2.00
mL. In some embodiments, the user may first depress a respective number
of button assemblies, effectively reducing the capacity of reservoir 908,
and then fill reservoir 908. Although a particular number of button
assemblies are shown, representing the exemplary embodiment, in other
embodiments, the number of button assemblies may vary from a minimum of 1
to as many as is desired. Additionally, although for descriptive
purposes, and in the exemplary embodiment, each button assembly may
displace 0.5 mL, in other embodiments, the volume of displacement per
button may vary. Additionally, the reservoir may be, in various
embodiments, include a larger or smaller volume than described in the
exemplary embodiment.
[0430] According to the above-described configuration, the button
assemblies (e.g., button assemblies 1014, 1016, 108) may employed, at
least in part, to control the fill volume of reservoir 908. By not
depressing any of the button assemblies, the greatest fill volume of
reservoir 908 may be achieved. Depressing one button assembly (e.g.,
button assembly 1014) may allow the second greatest fill volume to be
achieved. Depressing two button assemblies (e.g., button assemblies 1014,
1016) may achieve the third greatest fill volume. Depressing all three
button assemblies (e.g., button assemblies 1014, 1016, 1018) may allow
the smallest fill volume to be achieve.
[0431] Further, in an embodiment button assemblies 1014, 1016, 1018 may be
utilized, at least in part, to facilitate filling of reservoir 908. For
example, once a filling needle (e.g., which may be fluidly coupled to a
vial of infusible fluid) has been inserted into reservoir 908, button
assemblies 1014, 1016, 1018 may be depressed to pump at least a portion
of any air that may be contained within reservoir into the vial of
infusible fluid. Button assemblies 1014, 1016, 1018 may subsequently be
released to allow infusible fluid to flow from the vial into reservoir
908. Once reservoir 908 has been filled with the infusible fluid, one or
more button assemblies (e.g., one or more of button assemblies 1014,
1016, 1018) may be depressed, thereby squeezing at least a portion of the
infusible fluid from reservoir 908 (e.g., via a needle used to fill
reservoir 908 and back into the vial of infusible fluid). As discussed
above, the volume of infusible fluid contained within reservoir 908 may
be controlled, e.g., depending upon how many button assemblies are
depressed (e.g., which may control how much infusible fluid is squeezed
back into the vial of infusible fluid).
[0432] With particular reference to FIGS. 62-64, filling aid 1010 may be
pivotally coupled to fill adapter base plate 1020. For example, filling
aid 1010 may include pivot members 1022, 1024 that may be configured to
be received in pivot supports 1026, 1028, thereby allowing filling aid to
pivot between an open position (e.g., as shown in FIGS. 57-61) and a
closed position (e.g., as shown in FIGS. 63-64). The closed position may
be suitable, e.g., for packaging fill adapter 1000, storage of fill
adapter 1000, or the like. In order to ensure that filling aid 1010 is
properly oriented for filling reservoir 908, fill adapter 1000 may
include support member 1030. To properly orient filling aid 1010, a user
may pivot filling aid 1010 to a fully open position, wherein filling aid
1010 may contact support member 1030.
[0433] According to an alternative embodiment, and referring also to FIG.
65, fill adapter 1050 may be configured to releasably engage disposable
housing assembly 804 via a plurality of locking tabs (e.g., locking tabs
1052, 1054). Additionally, fill adapter 1050 may include a plurality of
button assemblies (e.g., button assemblies 1056, 1058, 1060) that may
interact with ribs 964, 966, 968 of disposable housing assembly 804 to
adjust a fill volume of reservoir 908. Fill adapter 1050 may further
include filling aid 1062, having guide passage 1064 configured to align a
needle of a syringe with the septum of disposable housing 804, e.g., for
accessing reservoir 908 for the purpose of filling reservoir 908 with an
infusible fluid. Filling aid 1062 may be connected to base plate 1066,
e.g., as an integral component therewith, by gluing, heat sealing,
compression fit, or the like.
[0434] Referring also to FIGS. 66-74, vial fill adapter 1100 may be
configured to facilitate filling reservoir 908 of disposable housing
assembly 804 directly from a vial. Similar to fill adapter 1000, vial
fill adapter 1100 may include locking tabs 1102, 1104, 1106, 1108 that
may be configured to engage radial tabs 934, 936, 938, 940 of disposable
housing assembly in a manner generally similar to tabs 942, 944, 946, 948
of locking ring assembly 806. Accordingly, vial fill adapter 1100 may be
releasably engaged with disposable housing assembly 804 by aligning vial
fill adapter 1100 with disposable housing assembly 804 and rotating vial
fill adapter 1100 and disposable housing assembly 804 relative to one
another to releasably engage locking tabs 1102, 1104, 1106, 1108 with
radial tabs 934, 936, 938, 940.
[0435] As discussed above, disposable housing assembly 804 may be
configured to facilitate controlling the quantity of infusible fluid
delivered to reservoir 908 during filling. For example, membrane assembly
902 of disposable housing assembly 804 may include ribs 964, 966, 968
that may be depressed and at least partially displaced into reservoir
908, thereby reducing the volume of reservoir 908. Accordingly, when
infusible fluid is delivered to reservoir 908, the volume of fluid that
may be accommodated by reservoir 908 may be correspondingly reduced. Ribs
964, 966, 968 may be accessible via openings 958, 960, 962 in top portion
904 of disposable housing assembly 804.
[0436] Vial fill adapter 1100 may include one or more button assemblies
(e.g., button assemblies 1110, 1112, 1114) corresponding to ribs 964,
966, 968 (e.g., shown in FIG. 52A). That is, when vial fill adapter 1100
is releasably engaged with disposable housing assembly 804, buttons 1110,
1112, 1114 may be aligned with ribs 964, 966, 968. Button assemblies
1110, 1112, 1114 may be, for example, cantilever members capable of being
depressed. When vial fill adapter 1100 is releasably engaged with
disposable housing assembly 804, one or more of button assemblies 1110,
1112, 1114 may be depressed, and may correspondingly displace a
respective one of ribs 964, 966, 698 into reservoir 908, thereby reducing
the volume of reservoir 908.
[0437] For example, assume for illustrative purposes that reservoir 908
has a maximum capacity of 3.00 mL. Further, assume that button assembly
1110 is configured to displace rib 964 into disposable housing assembly
804, resulting in a 0.5 mL reduction in the 3.00 mL capacity of
disposable housing assembly 804. Further, assume that button assembly
1112 is configured to displace rib 966 into disposable housing assembly
804, also resulting in a 0.5 mL reduction in the 3.00 mL capacity of
disposable housing assembly 804. Further, assume that button assembly
1114 is configured to displace rib 968 into disposable housing assembly
804, also resulting in a 0.50 mL reduction in the 3.00 mL capacity of
disposable housing assembly 804. Therefore, if the user wishes to fill
reservoir 908 within disposable housing assembly 804 with 2.00 mL of
infusible fluid, the user may depress button assemblies 1112 and 1114
(resulting in the displacement of ribs 966 and 968 into disposable
housing assembly 804), effectively reducing the 3.00 mL capacity of
reservoir 908 within disposable housing assembly 804 to 2.0 mL.
[0438] Vial fill adapter 1100 may further include vial filling aid
assembly 1116 that may be configured to fluidly couple a vial of
infusible fluid to reservoir 908 of disposable housing assembly 804 via a
septum. With particular reference to FIG. 71, vial filling aid assembly
may include double ended needle assembly 1118. Double ended needle
assembly 1118 may include first needle end 1120 configured to penetrate
the septum of a vial (not shown) and second needle end 1122 configured to
penetrate the septum of disposable housing assembly 804. As such, the
vial and reservoir 908 may be fluidly coupled allowing infusible fluid to
be transferred from the vial to reservoir 908. Double ended needle
assembly 1118 may include vial engagement portion 1124 adjacent first end
1120. Vial engagement arms 1124, 1126 may be configured to releasably
engage, e.g., a vial cap, to assist in maintaining the fluid connection
between double ended needle assembly 1118 and the vial. Additionally,
double ended needle assembly 1118 may include body 1128 that may be
slidably received in opening 1130 of vial filling aid body 1132. Vial
filling aid body 1132 may include stabilizer arms 1134, 1136, e.g., which
may be configured to stabilize the vial during filling of disposable
housing assembly 804. In one embodiment, the vial may be engaged with
double ended needle assembly 1118 e.g., such that first end 1120 may
penetrate the septum of the vial and the cap of the vial may be engaged
by engagement arms 1124, 1126. Body 1128 may be slidably inserted into
opening 1130 such that second end 1122 of double ended needle assembly
1118 may penetrate the septum of disposable body assembly 804.
[0439] Similar to fill adapter 1000, vial filling aid assembly 1116 may be
configured to be pivotally coupled to vial fill adapter base plate 1138.
For example, vial filling aid 1116 may include pivot members 1140, 1142
that may be configured to be received in pivot supports 1144, 1146 (e.g.,
shown in FIG. 71), thereby allowing vial filling aid 1116 to pivot
between an open position (e.g., as shown in FIGS. 66-70) and a closed
position (e.g., as shown in FIGS. 72-74). The closed position may be
suitable, e.g., for packaging vial fill adapter 1100, storage of vial
fill adapter 1100, or the like. In order to ensure that vial filling aid
1116 is properly oriented for filling reservoir 908, vial fill adapter
1100 may include support member 1148. To properly orient vial filling aid
1116, a user may pivot vial filling aid 1116 to a fully open position,
wherein vial filling aid 1116 may contact support member 1148.
Additionally, vial fill adapter base plate 1138 may include one or more
locking features (e.g., locking tabs 1150, 1152) that may engage vial
filing aid 1116, and may maintain vial filling aid 1116 in the closed
position. Vial fill adapter base plate 1138 may also include features
(e.g., tabs 1154, 1156) that may be configured to assist in retaining
double ended needle assembly 1118, e.g., by preventing slidable
separation of double ended needle assembly 1118 from vial filling aid
body 1132.
[0440] As shown in FIGS. 72-74, filling aid assembly 1116 is in a closed
position. In this configuration, support member 1148 may additionally
function as a needle guard. When removing filling aid assembly 1116 from
disposable housing assembly 804, support member 1148 may function to
safely allow a user to squeeze the ends and rotate filling aid assembly
1116 for removal. As shown in FIG. 70, in the open position, support
member 1148 may function as a stop to maintain proper orientation.
[0441] Referring again to FIGS. 57-73, the exemplary embodiments of the
fill adapter include a grip feature (e.g., 1166 in FIG. 72). Grip feature
1166 may provide a grip interface for removal of the fill adapter from
disposable housing assembly 804. Although shown in one configuration in
these figures, in other embodiments, the configuration may vary. In still
other embodiments, a grip feature may not be included.
[0442] According to one embodiment, fill adapter base plate 1020 and vial
fill adapter base plate 1138 may be interchangeable components.
Accordingly, a single base plate (e.g., either fill adapter base plate
1020 or vial fill adapter base plate 1138 may be used with either filling
aid 1010 or vial filling aid 1116. Accordingly, the number of distinct
components that are required for both filling adapters may be reduced,
and a user may have the ability to select the filling adapter that may be
the most suitable for a given filling scenario.
[0443] The various embodiments of the fill adapters may provide many
safely benefits, including but not limited to: providing a system for
filling the reservoir without handling a needle; protecting the reservoir
from unintentional contact with the needle, i.e., destruction of the
integrity of the reservoir through unintentional puncture; designed to be
ambidextrous; in some embodiments, may provide a system for maintaining
air in the reservoir.
[0444] According to other embodiments, the fill adapter may be configured
to meter the fluid dispensed into the reservoir or the disposable housing
assembly. Additionally/alternatively, the fill adapter may be configured
to positively dispense (e.g., pump) the fluid into the reservoir of the
disposable housing assembly. For example, and referring also to FIGS.
174-194, fill adapter 2700 may include a metering system for controlling
the amount of fluid dispensed into the reservoir of the disposable
housing assembly (e.g., reservoir 908 of disposable housing assembly 804
and a pumping mechanism for positively dispensing the fluid to reservoir
908. Generally, fill adapter 2700 may include a turn dial (e.g., turn
dial 2702) that may adjust the volume of fluid to be dispensed into
reservoir 908. For example, turn dial 2702 may actuate push plate 2704
(FIG. 181). Push plate 2704 may include one or more button features
(e.g., button features 2706, 2708, 2710 shown in FIG. 187, 188). Button
features 2706, 2708, 2710 may displace one or more of ribs 964, 966, 968
associated with reservoir 908, thereby reducing the available fill volume
of reservoir 908. The degree to which ribs 964, 966, 968 are displaced
may determine the available fill volume of reservoir 908 (as discussed
previously), and therefore also the volume of fluid that may be dispensed
into reservoir 908.
[0445] Turn dial 2702 and push plate 2704 may include cooperating features
that may enable turn dial 2702 to adjust the displacement of ribs 964,
966, 968 by push plate 2704. In one embodiment, turn dial 2702 and push
plate 2704 may include cooperating ramp features, e.g., threads 2712 of
push plate 2704 shown in FIG. 187. Turn dial 2702 may include cooperating
threads, such that when turn dial 2702 is turned in a first direction
(e.g., clockwise) push plate 2704 may be linearly moved in a first
direction to displace ribs 964, 966, 968 into reservoir 908 to decrease
the available fill volume of reservoir 908. Conversely, when turn dial
2707 is turned in a second direction (e.g., counterclockwise) push plate
2704 may be linearly moved in a second direction allowing ribs 964, 966,
968 to move to increase the available fill volume of reservoir 908. In
addition to cooperating ramp features, various additional/alternative
features may be utilized, including, but not limited to, cam features,
rack and pinion features, etc. Further, fill adapter 2700 may include one
or more return features (such as springs, or other bias members; not
shown) that may ensure that push plate 2704 is biased to increase the
available fill volume of reservoir 908 in response to turn dial 2702
being adjusted from a smaller available fill volume to a larger available
fill volume (e.g., as turn dial 2702 is turned in a counterclockwise
direction in foregoing example).
[0446] Additionally, while not shown, turn dial 2702 may be calibrated and
turn dial 2702 and/or housing 2714 may include indicia that may indicate
the available fill volume of reservoir 908 at a given rotational position
of turn dial 2702. For example, turn dial 2702 may include a pointer and
housing 2714 may include numerical indicia indicating available fill
volume of reservoir 908. As such, the available fill volume of reservoir
908 may be the numerical value indicated by the cooperation of the
pointer of turn dial 2702 and the numerical indicia of housing 2714.
[0447] As mentioned above, fill adapter 2700 may be configured to
positively dispense fluid into reservoir 908. In one embodiment, fill
adapter 2700 may include a pump mechanism configured to pump air into a
vial (e.g., vial 2716 shown in FIG. 181). For example, pumping air into
vial 2716 may pressurize vial 2716 to a pressure greater than a pressure
within reservoir 908. As such, when vial 2716 is fluidly coupled with
reservoir 908, the greater pressure within vial 2716 may force fluid
contained within vial 2716 into reservoir 908. Consistent with the
foregoing description, the volume of fluid transferred from vial 2716
into reservoir 908 may be controlled by turn dial 2702 and push plate
2704 (e.g., based upon, at least in part, the interaction between button
features 2706, 2708, 2710 and fingers 964, 966, 968).
[0448] The fill adapter may include a pump mechanism. According to one
embodiment, fill adapter 2700 may include pump bulb 2718, which may
include a flexible convex member that may be biased toward a first
volume, and compressible to a second volume that is less than the first
volume. For example, pump bulb 2718 may be compressed from the first
volume to the second volume when pump bulb 2718 is pressed by a user's
thumb or finger. While not shown, a pumping volume (e.g., the difference
between the first volume and the second volume of pump bulb 2718) may be
controlled at least in part, by turn dial 2702. For example, the pumping
volume may be controlled by turn dial 2702 to correspond to the available
fill volume of reservoir 908 (e.g., the pumping volume may be a pumping
volume of air that may result a transfer of a volume of fluid generally
equal to the available fill volume of reservoir 908).
[0449] Further, while not shown, pump bulb 2718 may include an inlet
having an associated one-way valve that may allow air to enter pump bulb
2718 via the inlet when pump bulb 2718 expands from the second volume to
the first volume, and may prevent air from exiting inlet when pump bulb
2718 is compressed from the first volume to the second volume.
Additionally, while also not shown, pump bulb 2718 may include an outlet
having an associated one-way valve that may allow air to exit pump bulb
2718 via the outlet when pump bulb 2718 is compressed from the first
volume to the second volume, and may prevent air from entering pump bulb
2718 via the outlet when pump bulb 2718 expands from the second volume to
the first volume. Various valve mechanisms may be employed for the
one-way inlet valve and the one-way outlet valve, including, but not
limited to, ball valves, flap valves, diaphragm valves, and the like.
[0450] In various additional/alternative embodiments the pump mechanism
may include, but is not limited to, a piston pump, a diaphragm pump, or
the like. Further, while pump bulb 2718 has been described as being
compressed by a user's thumb or finger, various additional/alternative
embodiments of a pump mechanism may be actuated by a turn crank, a lever,
a pair of squeeze handles, a foot pump, and/or various other means of
actuation.
[0451] The outlet of pump bulb 2718 may be fluidly coupled to pressure
needle 2720 (FIG. 181). Pressure needle 2720 may be configured to
penetrate a septum of vial 2716. As such, when pressure needle 2720 has
penetrated the septum of vial 2716 and pump bulb 2718 is pumped (e.g., by
compressing pump bulb 2718 from the first volume to the second volume)
air may be transferred from pump bulb 2718 into vial 2716. The transfer
of air from pump bulb 2718 into vial 2716 may increase the internal
pressure within vial 2716. The one way valve associated with the outlet
of pump bulb 2718 may prevent the retrograde flow of fluid from vial 2716
into pump bulb 2718 via pressure needle 2720. Additionally, as
schematically shown in FIG. 194, hydrophobic filter 2722 may be
associated with pressure needle 2720. Hydrophobic filter 2722 may include
any variety of gas-permeable hydrophobic materials, such as a POREX.TM.
material, a GORE.TM. material, or the like (POREX is a trademark of Porex
Corporation in the United States and/or other countries, GORE is a trade
mark of W.L. Gore & Associates, Inc. in the Unites States and/or other
countries). Hydrophobic filter 2722 may allow the transmission of gaseous
fluids (such as air), but may resist/prevent the passage of liquids (such
as insulin or various other infusion fluids). Additionally, hydrophobic
filter 2722 may have a restricted flow rate of gaseous fluids, and may,
therefore, control the rate at which air can be pumped out of pump bulb
2718 and into vial 2716.
[0452] Fill adapter 2700 may further include a transfer needle (e.g.,
transfer needle 2724 shown in FIG. 181). Transfer needle 2724 may allow
fluid to be transferred from vial 2716 to reservoir 908 of disposable
housing assembly 804. Referring also to FIG. 183, in a "fill
configuration" of fill adapter 2700, transfer needle 2724 may extend into
recess 2726 of fill adapter 2700. Recess 2726 of fill adapter 2700 may be
configured to at least partially receive disposable housing assembly 804.
Further, fill adapter 2700 may be configured to align (e.g., via openings
2728, 2730 configured to cooperate with alignment tabs 930, 932 of
disposable housing assembly 804) disposable housing assembly 804 relative
to fill adapter 2700, such that transfer needle 2724 may be aligned to
penetrate a septum of disposable housing assembly 804 to transfer fluid
from vial 2716 into reservoir 908 of disposable housing assembly 804.
[0453] As shown in the schematic view of FIG. 194, pressure needle 2720
may be configured to extend farther into vial 2716 than transfer needle
2724. The foregoing configuration may reduce the likelihood that air
introduced into vial 2716 by pump bulb 2718 may be transferred via
transfer needle 2724. That is, in operation pressure needle 2720 may be
at a higher relative position within vial 2716 as compared to transfer
needle 2724. As such, air bubble rising within vial 2716 (which may
contain a liquid to be transferred to reservoir 908) may not pass by, and
be drawn into, transfer needle 2724, as transfer needle 2724 may be at a
lower relative position within vial 2617 as compared to pressure needle.
[0454] Pressure needle 2720 and transfer needle 2724 may be retained by
vial adapter 2732 (FIG. 193). Additionally, vial adapter 2732 may include
vial receptacle 2734 that may be configured to at least partially receive
vial 2716 and align pressure needle 2720 and transfer needle 2724 with
the septum of vial 2716. As such, insertion of vial 2716 into vial
receptacle 2734 may align pressure needle 2720 and transfer needle 2724
with the septum of vial 2716 without the need for further alignment by
the user. Further, vial adapter 2732 may retain pressure needle 2720 and
transfer needle 2724 in a desired relative alignment, such that pressure
needle 2720 may extend farther into vial 2716 than transfer needle 2724,
as described above.
[0455] Also referring to FIGS. 199A-199H, vial adapter 2732 may be
configured to be received in receptacle 2736 of main plate 2738 of fill
adapter 2700 (also see FIG. 181). Vial adapter 2732 may include needle
carriage 2732a as well as one or more tabs (e.g., tabs 2732b, 2732c). In
some embodiments, vial 2716 may be removed from vial adapter 2732 by
pulling up on vial 2716. Pulling up on vial 2716 may also cause needle
carriage 2732a to move upwards until being engaged by the tabs 2732b,
2732c. Fingers 2733a, 2733b may be depressed by the user. In some
embodiments, depressing fingers 2733a, 2733b may push vial 2716 further
upward, and may disconnect vial 2716 from needles 2720, 2724. As such,
the safety of removing vial 2716 from vial adapter 2732 may be improved.
In some embodiments, vial adapter 2732 may additionally include seal
2735a and hydrophobic filter 2735b. However, in other embodiments, the
vial adapter 2732 may include a check valve.
[0456] Referring also to FIG. 184, in an embodiment pressure needle 2720
may terminate within vial adapter 2732, and may be fluidly coupled to
opening 2740 of vial adapter 2732. When vial adapter 2732 is assembled
with main plate 2738, opening 2740 may be fluidly coupled with the outlet
of pump bulb 2718 such that air pumped out of pump bulb 2718 may be
received through opening 2740 and transferred to vial 2716 via pressure
needle 2720.
[0457] In operation, to fill a disposable housing assembly 804, a user
couples the vial adapter 2732 to the main plate 2738. The vial 2716 is
then coupled to the vial adapter 2732. In performing these steps (see
also FIGS. 199A-199H) the transfer needle 2724 penetrates the septum of
the disposable housing assembly 804 (see 199D) and also, the septum of
the vial 2716 (see FIG. 199E). Thus, in various embodiments, the transfer
needle 2724 does not penetrate the septum of the vial 2716 until the
transfer needle 2724 also penetrates the septum of the disposable housing
assembly 804. This ensures that if the vial 2716 is pressurized, the
contents of the vial 2716 will not begin to flow until the transfer
needle 2724 has penetrated the septum of the disposable housing assembly
804, thereby limiting the amount of wasted vial contents.
[0458] Thus, to fill a disposable housing assembly 804, the user may
couple disposable housing assembly 804 in recess 2726 of main plate 2738
(e.g., including aligning disposable housing assembly 804 relative to
fill adapter 2700 via openings 2728, 2730 configured to at least
partially receive alignment tabs 930, 932 of disposable housing assembly
804). Disposable housing assembly 804 may be retained relative to fill
adapter 2700 using bottom door 2742, which may pivotally close to at
least partially cover recess 2726 to retain disposable housing assembly
804 at least partially within recess 2726. A user may then couple the
vial adapter 2732 to the main plate 2738 and then, couple a vial 2716 to
the vial adapter 2732. Coupling vial adapter 2732 to main plate 2738 may
result in transfer needle 2724 penetrating the septum of disposable
housing assembly 804. Additionally, coupling vial adapter 2732 to main
plate 2738 may couple opening 2740 with the outlet of pump bulb 2718. The
user may then adjust turn dial 2702 (e.g., which may thereby cause
movement of push plate 2704) to the desired available fill volume of
reservoir 908. The user may then actuate pump bulb 2718 (e.g., by
compressing and releasing pump bulb 2718). The user may continue to
actuate pump bulb 2718 until no more bubbles are observed rising within
vial 2716 (e.g., rising from pressure needle 2720).
Additionally/alternatively, pump bulb 2718 may be configured such that a
single complete actuation of pump bulb 2718 may be sufficient to effect a
complete transfer (e.g., the volume of air transferred from pump bulb
2718 to vial 2716 during a single actuation of pump bulb 2718 may be
sufficient to produce the transfer of the maximum fill volume of
reservoir 908). According to one embodiment, fill adapter 2700 may be
configured to overfill reservoir 908 (e.g., to transfer a volume of fluid
from vial 2716 that is at least partially greater than the available fill
volume of reservoir 908, as determined by the settings of turn dial
2702). Overfilling reservoir 908 may allow the fluid passages associated
with disposable housing assembly 804 to be primed with fluid, thereby
obviating the need to later prime the fluid lines of disposable housing
assembly 804.
[0459] Still referring to FIGS. 199A-199H, in some embodiments, the fill
adapter 2700 includes vial fingers 2744a, 2744b. As shown in FIGS.
199A-199H, as the vial 2716 is introduced to the vial adapter 2732, the
vial 2716 overcomes the spring force of the vial fingers 2744a, 2744b.
However, as the vial 2716 reaches a end on the needle carriage 2732a, the
vial fingers 2744a, 2744b return force and act to maintain the position
of the vial 2716.
[0460] Referring now to FIGS. 200-202B, another embodiment of the fill
adapter is 2750 is shown. In various embodiments of this embodiment of
the fill adapter, the vial adapter 2762 includes a needle carriage 2754
which includes vial needles 2756a, 2756b and transfer needle 2756c. In
some embodiments, the needles 2756a, 2756b, 2756c are 24 gauge stainless
steel. However, in other embodiments, the gauge of the needles may vary.
In various embodiments, the gauge of needle is a balance between
flexibility and efficiency.
[0461] The needle carriage 2754 is slidably engaged to the interior of the
vial adapter housing 2752. The vial adapter 2762 includes a check valve
2758 and a filter 2766. In some embodiments, the filter 2766 may be a 0.2
micron filter, or any other filter that prevents dust and other unwanted
particulate matter, from entering the air line and the vial (not shown).
In the exemplary embodiment, the filter 2766 is a hydrophobic filter
which may include any variety of gas-permeable hydrophobic materials,
such as a POREX.TM. material, a GORE.TM. material, or the like (POREX is
a trademark of Porex Corporation in the United States and/or other
countries, GORE is a trade mark of W.L. Gore & Associates, Inc. in the
Unites States and/or other countries). In some embodiments, the check
valve 2758 is a duck bill valve. The duck bill valve serves as a check
valve and a seal. However, in other embodiments, the check valve may be
any type of check valve. In other embodiments, the check valve is not
included and only a hydrophobic filter is used. In some embodiments, the
hydrophobic filter my be as described above, and in these embodiments, a
separate seal may also be used.
[0462] The vial adapter 2762 further includes a vial adapter housing 2752.
The housing contains the needle carriage 2754 and is adapted to removably
attach to the fill adapter base 2768 by way of the receptacle 2770. The
fill adapter base 2768 includes a main plate 2760 which includes the
receptacle 2770. The receptacle 2770 includes at least one key, and in
the exemplary embodiment, the receptacle 2770 includes two keys 2764b.
The keys 2764b in the exemplary embodiment, are differently sized,
however, in other embodiments, they may be the same size. The different
sizes of the keys 2764b allows for the vial adapter 2762 to be located in
the intended orientation. The keys 2764b fit into locking features 2764a
located inside the vial adapter housing 2752. Once the keys 2764b and
locking features 2764a are fit together, a clockwise turn of the vial
adapter 2762 locks the vial adapter 2762 to the receptacle 2770. However,
in various other embodiments, the locking features 2764a located inside
the vial adapter housing 2752 may be designed such that a
counterclockwise turn of the vial adapter 2762 locks the vial adapter
2762 to the receptacle 2770.
[0463] Locking the vial adapter 2762 to the receptacle 2770 may be
desirable for many reasons, including, but not limited to, maintaining
the correct orientation during fill and preventing the needles from
bending or twisting during fill. The locking system described above also
ensures correct orientation of the vial adapter with respect to the fill
adapter base 2768.
[0464] Referring now to FIGS. 203A-203J, in operation, to fill a
disposable housing assembly 804, a user couples the vial adapter 2762 to
the receptacle 2770. The vial adapter 2762 is then rotated clockwise,
locking the vial adapter 2762 to the receptacle 2770 (see FIG. 203C). The
vial 2716 is then coupled to the vial adapter 2762. In performing these
steps the transfer needle 2756c penetrates the septum of the disposable
housing assembly 804 (see 203E) and also, the septum of the vial 2716
(see FIG. 203F). Thus, in various embodiments, the transfer needle 2756c
does not penetrate the septum of the vial 2716 until the transfer needle
2756c also penetrates the septum of the disposable housing assembly 804.
This ensures that if the vial 2716 is pressurized, the contents of the
vial 2716 will not begin to flow until the transfer needle 2756c has
penetrated the septum of the disposable housing assembly 804, thereby
limiting the amount of wasted vial contents.
[0465] Thus, to fill a disposable housing assembly 804, in this
embodiment, the user couples the disposable housing assembly 804 to the
fill adapter base 2768 in a similar fashion as described above with
respect to the fill adapter 2700. A user may then couples the vial
adapter 2762 to the receptacle 2770, turns the vial adapter 2762, locking
the vial adapter 2762 to the receptacle, and then, couples a vial 2716 to
the vial adapter 2762. The user may then adjust the turn dial and follow
similar a similar process as described above with respect to the fill
adapter 2700 for filling the disposable housing assembly 804.
[0466] Referring to FIGS. 203D-203F, introducing the vial 2716 to the vial
adapter 2762, vial fingers 2772a, 2772b, including a bent portion that
grasps and holds the narrow portion of the vial 2716. However, as shown
in FIG. 203F, in some embodiments, a distance remains between the top of
the vial 2716 (i.e., the area including the septum) and the bent portion
of the vial fingers 2772a, 2772b. As shown in FIG. 203G, to remove the
vial, a user applies force to the vial 2716 in an upward direction. The
upward force first pulls the vial 2716 upwards such that the needles
2756a, 2756b are no longer in contact with the contents of the vial 2716,
rather, the needles 2756a, 2756b are inside the septum of the vial 2716.
This ensures that if the vial 2716 is pressurized, the contents of the
vial 2716 will not continue to flow while the vial 2716 is being removed
from the vial adapter 2756 thereby limiting the amount of wasted vial
contents.
[0467] Referring to FIG. 203E, the vial adapter 2762 additionally includes
a disc 2774 (see also FIG. 200). The disc 2774 remains at the bottom of
the vial adapter 2762 (which may also be referred to as the receptacle
end of the vial adapter 2762) until the needle carriage 2754 reaches the
bottom of the vial adapter 2762. Referring to FIG. 203E, the needle
carriage 2754 having reached the bottom of the vial adapter 2762, the
needle carriage 2754 is now connected to the disc 2774. The disc 2774
includes features which mate with the needle carriage 2754 such that,
when the needle carriage 2754 moves upward, or towards the top or vial
end of the vial adapter 2762, as seen in FIG. 203H, the disc 2774
accompanies the needle carriage 2754.
[0468] Referring now to FIGS. 204A-204C, a sequence showing the
progression of the needle carriage 2754 and the relationship of the
needle carriage 2754 with the disc 2774 is shown without a vial. As seen
in FIG. 204C, once the needle carriage 2754, together with the disc 2774,
reach the top section of the vial adapter 2762, the disc 2774 is locked
in place by the wall features of the vial adapter 2762.
[0469] Referring now to FIGS. 2031-203K, after the vial 2716 is lifted
outside of the vial adapter 2762, the vial adapter 2762 may be rotated
counter clockwise (FIG. 203J), unlocking the vial adapter 2762 from the
receptacle 2770, and the vial adapter 2762 may then be lifted off the
fill adapter base 2768 (FIG. 203K). Additionally, as is shown in FIG.
203K, the needles 2756a, 2756b, 2756c are contained within the vial
adapter 2762 thus protecting the user and others from interaction with
the needles 2756a, 2756b, 2756c.
[0470] Referring also to FIGS. 195A-198, another embodiment of a fill
adapter (e.g., fill adapter 2800) is shown. Fill adapter 2800 may be
generally similar to fill adapter 2700, including a turn dial (e.g., turn
dial 2802) that may actuate a push plate (e.g., push plate 2804) for
setting an available fill volume of reservoir 908 of disposable housing
assembly 804 (FIGS. 197-198). Fill adapter 2800 may also include vial
adapter 2806 configured to releasably couple a vial to fill adapter 2800
for transferring fluid from the vial to reservoir 908 of disposable
housing assembly 804. Fill adapter 2806 may include a pressure needle
and/or a transfer needle respectively configured to introduce air into
the vial and allow fluid to be transferred from the vial to reservoir 908
of disposable housing assembly 804. While fill adapter 2800 is shown
including recess 2808 and pivoting door 2810 for retaining disposable
housing assembly to fill adapter 2800, in other embodiments, the fill
adapter may utilize locking features, e.g., which may releasably engage
tabs 934, 936, 938, 940 disposable housing assembly 804.
[0471] With respect to the embodiments including a vial adapter removably
connectable to a fill adapter base, in some embodiments, the vial adapter
may be a one-use, i.e., disposable portion, and the fill adapter base may
be a multi-use, i.e., reusable, portion. In some embodiments, upon
removal of the vial from the vial adapter, the needle carriage becomes
locked in the end position. This may be desirable to prevent reuse and
reuse may contaminate vials and disposable housing assemblies, for the
transfer needle may become contaminated while stored between uses.
[0472] Fill adapter 2800 may include actuation button 2812, which may be
disposed in turn dial 2802. Actuation button 2812 may be configured as a
plunger pump, e.g., which may pump air into the vial to effectuate fluid
transfer from the vial into reservoir 908, in a manner as described
above. Various additional/alternative pumping mechanisms may similarly be
used, as described above. Additionally, actuation button 2812 may operate
a bias member (e.g., spring 2814) that may limit the amount of force that
is transferred to reservoir 908. For example, spring 2814 may be disposed
between actuation button 2812 and the pumping member that may actually
pump air into the vial. As such, the force that may be transferred to
reservoir 908 may be limited to the spring force of spring 2814.
[0473] As discussed above, reusable housing assembly 802 may include
battery 832, e.g., which may include a rechargeable battery. Referring
also to FIGS. 75-80, battery charger 1200 may be configured to recharge
battery 832. Battery charger 1200 may include housing 1202 having top
plate 1204. Top plate 1204 may include one or more electrical contacts
1206, generally, configured to be electrically coupled to electrical
contacts 834 of reusable housing assembly 802. Electrical contacts 1206
may include, but are not limited to, electrical contact pads, spring
biased electrical contact members, or the like. Additionally, top plate
1204 may include alignment tabs 1208, 1210, which may be configured to
mate with openings 836, 838 in base plate 818 of reusable housing
assembly 802 (e.g., as shown in FIG. 35C). The cooperation of alignment
tabs 1208, 1210 and openings 836, 838 may ensure that reusable housing
assembly 802 is aligned with battery charger 1200 such that electrical
contacts 1206 of battery charger 1200 may electrically couple with
electrical contacts 834 of reusable housing assembly 802.
[0474] With reference also to FIGS. 77 and 78, battery charger 1200 may be
configured to releasably engage reusable housing assembly 802. For
example, in a similar manner as disposable housing assembly 804, battery
charger 1200 may include one or more locking tabs (e.g., locking tabs
1212, 1214 shown in FIG. 76). The locking tabs (e.g., locking tabs 1212,
1214) may be engaged by tabs 942, 944, 946, 948 of locking ring assembly
806. As such, reusable housing assembly 802 may be aligned with battery
charger 1200 (via alignment tabs 1208, 1210) with locking ring 806 in a
first, unlocked position, as shown in FIG. 77. Locking ring 806 may be
rotated relative to battery charger 1200 in the direction of arrow 1216
to releasably engage tabs 942, 944, 946, 948 of locking ring 806 with the
locking tabs (e.g., locking tabs 1212, 1214) of battery charger 1200, as
shown in FIG. 78.
[0475] In an embodiment, battery charger 1200 may include recessed region
1218, e.g., which may, in the exemplary embodiments, provide clearance to
accommodate reusable housing assembly 802 pumping and valving components.
Referring also to FIGS. 79 & 80, battery charger 1200 may provide
electrical current to electrical contacts 1206 (and thereby to reusable
housing assembly 802 via electrical contacts 834) for recharging battery
832 of reusable housing assembly 802. In some embodiments, when a signal
indicative of a fully engaged reusable housing is not provided, current
may not be provided to electrical contacts 1206. According to such an
embodiment, the risk associated with an electrical short circuit (e.g.,
resulting from foreign objects contacting electrical contacts 1206) and
damage to reusable housing assembly 802 (e.g., resulting from improper
initial alignment between electrical contacts 1206 and electrical
contacts 834) may be reduced. Additionally, battery charger 1200 may not
unnecessarily draw current when battery charger is not charging reusable
housing assembly 802.
[0476] Still referring to FIGS. 79 and 80, battery charger 1200 may
include a lower housing portion 1224 and top plate 1204. Printed circuit
board 1222 (e.g., which may include electrical contacts 1206) may be
disposed within a cavity included between top plate 1204 and lower
housing portion 1224.
[0477] Referring also to FIGS. 81-89B, various embodiments of battery
charger/docking stations are shown. FIGS. 81 and 82 depicts desktop
charger 1250 including recess 1252 configured to mate with and recharge a
reusable housing assembly (e.g., reusable housing assembly 802). The
reusable housing assembly may rest in recess 1252 and or may be
releasably engaged in recess 1252, in a similar manner as discussed
above. Additionally, desktop charger 1250 may include recess 1254
configured to mate with a remote control assembly (e.g., remote control
assembly 300). Recess 1254 may include a USB plug 1256, e.g., which may
be configured to couple with the remote control assembly when the remote
control assembly is disposed within recess 1254. USB plug 1256 may allow
for data transfer to/from the remote control assembly, as well as
charging of remote control assembly. Desktop charger 1250 may also
include USB port 1258 (e.g., which may include a mini-USB port), allowing
desktop charger to receive power (e.g., for charging the reusable housing
assembly and/or the remote control assembly). Additionally/alternatively
USB port 1258 may be configured for data transfer to/from remote control
assembly and/or reusable housing assembly, e.g., by connection to a
computer (not shown).
[0478] Referring to FIGS. 83A-83B, similar to the previous embodiment,
desktop charger 1260 may include recess 1262 for mating with a reusable
housing assembly (e.g., reusable housing assembly 1264). Desktop charger
may also include recess 1266 configured to receive a remote control
assembly (e.g., remote control assembly 1268). One or more of recess
1262, 1266 may include electrical and/or data connections configure to
charge and/or transfer data to/from reusable housing assembly 1262 and/or
remote control assembly 1268, respectively.
[0479] Referring to FIGS. 84A-84B, another embodiment of a desktop charger
is shown. Similar to desktop charger 1260, desktop charger 1270 may
include recesses (not shown) for respectively mating with reusable
housing assembly 1272 and remote control assembly 1274. As shown, desktop
charger 1270 may hold reusable housing assembly 1272 and remote control
assembly 1274 in a side-by-side configuration. Desktop charger 1270 may
include various electrical and data connection configured to charge
and/or transfer data to/from reusable housing assembly 1272 and/or remote
control assembly 1274, as described in various embodiments above.
[0480] Referring to FIG. 85A-85D, collapsible charger 1280 may include
recess 1282 for receiving reusable housing assembly 1284 and remote
control assembly 1286. Collapsible charger 1280 may include various
electrical and data connection configured to charge and/or transfer data
to/from reusable housing assembly 1284 and/or remote control assembly
1286, as described in various embodiments above. Additionally, as shown
in FIGS. 85B-85D, collapsible charger 1280 may include pivotable cover
1288. Pivotable cover 1288 may be configured to pivot between an open
position (e.g., as shown in FIG. 85B), in which reusable housing assembly
1284 and remote control assembly 1286 may be docked in collapsible
charger 1280, and a closed position (e.g., as shown in FIG. 85D), in
which recess 1282 may be covered by pivotable cover 1288. In the closed
position, recess 1282, as well as any electrical and/or data connections
disposed therein, may be protected from damage.
[0481] Referring to FIG. 86, wall charger 1290 may include recess 1292
configured to receive reusable housing assembly 1294. Additionally, wall
charger 1290 may include recess 1296 configured to receive remote control
assembly 1298. Reusable housing assembly 1294 and remote control assembly
1298 may be positioned in a stacked configuration, e.g., thereby
providing a relatively slim profile. A rear portion of wall charger 1290
may include an electrical plug, configured to allow wall charger to be
plugged into an electrical receptacle. As such, wall charger 1290, while
plugged into the electrical receptacle, may achieve a wall mounted
configuration. Additionally, while plugged into the electrical
receptacle, wall charger 1290 may be provided with power for charging
reusable housing assembly 1294 and/or remote control assembly 1298.
[0482] Referring to FIG. 87, wall charger 1300 may include recess 1302
configured to receive remote control assembly 1304. Additionally, wall
charger may include a recess (not shown) configured to receive reusable
housing assembly 1306. Wall charger 1300 may be configured to position
remote control assembly 1304 and reusable housing assembly 1306 in a
back-to-back configuration, which may provide a relatively thin profile.
Additionally, wall charger 1300 may include an electrical plug 1308
configured to be plugged into an electrical receptacle. Electrical plug
1308 may include a stowable configuration, in which electrical plug 1308
may be pivotable between a deployed position (e.g., as shown), and a
stowed position. In the deployed position, electrical plug 1308 may be
oriented to be plugged into an electrical receptacle. In the stowed
position electrical plug 1308 may be disposed within recess 1310, which
may protect electrical plug 1308 from damage and/or from damaging other
items.
[0483] Referring to FIG. 88, charger 1320 may include recess 1322
configured to receive reusable housing assembly 1324. Charger 1320 may
additionally include a recess (not shown) configured to receive remote
control assembly 1326. Charger 1320 may additionally include cover 1328.
Cover 1328 may be configured to pivot between an open position (as shown)
and a closed position. When cover 1328 is in the open position, reusable
housing assembly 1324 and remote control assembly 1326 may be accessible
(e.g., allowing a user to remove/install reusable housing assembly 1324
and/or remote control assembly 1326 from/into charger 1320. When cover
1324 is in the closed position, cover 1328 and charger body 1330 may
substantially enclose reusable housing assembly 1324 and/or remote
control assembly 1326 and/or recess 1322 and the recess configured to
receive remote control assembly 1326, thereby providing damage and/or
tamper protection for reusable housing assembly 1324, remote control
assembly 1326 and/or any electrical and/or data connection associated
with charger 1320.
[0484] Referring to FIGS. 89A-89B, wall charger 1350 may include recess
1352 configured to receive remote control assembly 1354. Wall charger
1350 may also include recess 1356 configured to receive reusable housing
assembly 1358. Wall charger 1350 may be configured to position remote
control assembly 1354 and reusable housing assembly 1358 in a generally
side-by-side configuration, thereby providing a relatively slim profile.
Charger 1350 may additionally include electrical plug 1360, e.g., which
may be configured to be plugged into an electrical receptacle. Electrical
plug 1360 may include a stowable configuration, in which electrical plug
1360 may be pivotable between a deployed position (e.g., as shown), and a
stowed position. In the deployed position, electrical plug 1360 may be
oriented to be plugged into an electrical receptacle. In the stowed
position electrical plug 1360 may be disposed within recess 1362, which
may protect electrical plug 1308 from damage and/or from damaging other
items.
[0485] Referring also to FIGS. 134 through 145, another embodiment of a
battery charger (e.g., charger 2600), which may be used to recharge
battery 832 of reusable housing assembly 802, is shown. Similar to
previously discussed embodiments, charger 2600 may be configured to
charge both a reusable housing assembly (e.g., reusable housing assembly
802), as well as a companion remote control assembly (e.g., remote
control assembly 2602). For example, charger 2600 may include reusable
housing assembly charging portion 2604 configured to cooperate with
reusable housing assembly 802, for the charging thereof. As shown,
reusable housing assembly charging portion
[0486] 2604 may include a recess in top cover 2606 of charger 2600 that
may at least partially receive reusable housing assembly 802. In a
similar manner as discussed above, reusable housing assembly charging
portion 2604 may include one or more alignment tabs (e.g., alignment tabs
2608, 2610) that may be configured to mate with openings 836, 838 in base
plate 818 of reusable housing assembly 802 (shown in FIG. 35C). The
alignment of tabs 2608, 2610 and openings 836, 838 may ensure that
reusable housing assembly 802 is aligned with reusable housing assembly
charging portion 2604 such that electrical contacts of charger 2600
(e.g., contacts 2612) may electrically couple with electrical contacts
834 of reusable housing assembly 802.
[0487] Also, in a similar manner as discussed above, reusable housing
assembly charging portion 2604 may be configured to releasably engage
reusable housing assembly 802. For example, in a similar manner as
disposable housing assembly 804, reusable housing assembly charging
portion 2604 may include one or more locking tabs (e.g., locking tabs
2614, 2616, 2618 visible in FIG. 134). The locking tabs (e.g., locking
tabs 2614, 2616, 2618) may be engaged by tabs 942, 944, 946, 948 of
locking ring assembly 806. As such, reusable housing assembly 802 may be
aligned with charger 2600 (via alignment tabs 2608, 2610) with locking
ring 806 in a first, unlocked position, and locking ring 806 may be
rotated relative to charger 2600 in a first direction (e.g., clockwise in
an exemplary embodiment) to releasably engage tabs 942, 944, 946, 948 of
locking ring 806 with the locking tabs (e.g., locking tabs 2614, 2616,
2618) of charger 2600. In some embodiments, reusable housing assembly
charging portion 2604 may include recess 2620 configured to receive
locking ring nub 808, e.g., which may further ensure proper alignment of
reusable housing assembly 802 with charger 2600. Additionally, as shown,
top cover 2606 may include a recess (e.g., recess 2622) adjacent to
reusable housing assembly charging portion 2604 that may facilitate
removal of reusable housing assembly 802 from charger 2600 (e.g., by
allowing a user to at least partially grip reusable housing assembly 802
with a thumb or finger). Additionally, recess 2622 may facilitates
opening of lid 2626.
[0488] In addition to reusable housing assembly charging portion 2604,
charger 2600 may include remote control assembly charging portion 2624,
e.g., that may allow companion remote control assembly 2602 to be charged
along with reusable housing assembly 802. In the exemplary embodiment,
remote control assembly charging portion 2624 is configured to receive a
remote control. In some embodiments, the remote control may include a
glucose strip reader on portion of the remote control intended to be
placed into remote control assembly charging portion 2624. In these
embodiments, remote control assembly charging portion 2624 may accepts
the remote control during charging such that the strip reader may be
blocked by remote control assembly charging portion 2624. This may be
desirable to prevent a user from using the glucose strip reader while the
remote control is on the charger.
[0489] Remote control assembly charging portion 2624 may include a recess
configured to receive at least a portion of remote control assembly 2602.
Charger 2600 may include lid 2626, e.g., which may be adjacent to, and/or
at least partially define, remote control assembly charging portion. For
example, lid 2626 may, in an open position, extend generally upwardly
relative to top cover 2606. Further, lid 2626 may include surface 2628
that may be at least generally aligned with remote control assembly
charging portion 2624. As such, lid 2626 may facilitate insertion of
remote control assembly 2602 into remote control assembly charging
portion 2624 (e.g., by allowing remote control assembly to generally
slide downwardly along surface 2628 and into remote control assembly
charging portion 2624). Additionally, lid 2626 may support remote control
assembly 2602 while coupled in remote control assembly charging portion
2624 (e.g., to reduce stress imparted on remote control assembly 2602
from being bumped, etc., from being transferred to electrical connection
or the like associated with remote control assembly charging portion
2624).
[0490] With particular reference also to FIGS. 136-137, charger 2600 may
include lock cover 2630, e.g., which may at least partially conceal
and/or protect reusable housing assembly charging portion 2604 when not
in use (e.g., when a reusable housing assembly is not being charged or
stored on charger 2600). In a similar manner to reusable housing assembly
802, lock cover 2630 may include one or more locking tabs that may
interact with the locking tabs of charger 2600 (e.g., locking tabs 2614,
2616, 2618) to allow releasable engagement of lock cover 2630 with
reusable housing assembly charging portion 2604. As shown in FIG. 137,
lock cover 2630 may provide protection for/concealment of reusable
housing assembly charging portion 2604, e.g., without impeding access to
and/or the use of remote control assembly charging portion 2624. As such,
reusable housing assembly charging portion 2604 may be
protected/concealed while still allowing remote control assembly 2602 to
be charged by/reside in charger 2600. Further, while not shown, when
neither reusable housing assembly charging portion 2604 nor remote
control assembly charging portion 2624 are in use, lid 2626 may be
pivoted to a closed position, e.g., disposed over both reusable housing
assembly charging portion 2604 and remote control assembly charging
portion 2624. As such, in the closed position lid 2626 may provide
protection for charger 2600 when charger 2600 is not in use.
[0491] Referring also to FIGS. 139-145, charger 2600 is shown in various
exploded, and partially exploded views. As shown, lid 2626 may include
integrated shaft portions 2632, 2634 that may be at least partially
received in cooperating recesses in the rear of top cover 2606 (FIG.
140). Printed circuit board 2636, including the various electronics
associated with charger 2600, may be mounted to the rear or top cover
2606, e.g., using screws, heat-staked posts, or other suitable fastening
means (FIG. 141). Lid closure features 2638, 2640 may be received in top
cover 2606 at least partially engaging shaft portions 2632, 2634. Bias
members 2642, 2644 may bias lid closure features 2638, 2640 into
engagement with shaft portions 2632, 2634 (FIG. 142). Bias members 2642,
2644 may include a resilient material, such as silicone, rubber, or the
like, and/or may include springs or other biasing structures. In one
embodiment, shaft portions 2632, 2634 may include features (e.g., flatted
regions, etc.) that may interact with lid closure features 2638, 2640
when lid 2626 is in, or close to, a fully open and/or a fully closed
position. The interaction between lid closure features 2638, 2640 and
shaft portions 2632, 2634 may bias lid 2626 to the fully open and/or the
fully closed position.
[0492] Intermediate tray 2646 may be secured to top cover 2606 via plate
2648, which may itself be secured to top cover 2606 using screws,
heat-stake posts, adhesive, or other suitable fastening means (FIG. 143).
Intermediate tray 2646 may include a recess at least partially defining
the remote control assembly charging portion 2624 of charger 2600.
Additionally, intermediate tray 2646 may include opening 2650 configured
to at least partially receive electrical connector 2652 coupled to
printed circuit board 2636 (e.g., capable of establishing an electrical
connection between charger 2600 and remote control assembly 2602). Plate
2648 may include, for example, a stamped metal plate. Additionally, plate
2648 may increase the weight of charger 2600, which may allow charger
2600 to resist tipping and/or facilitate one handed installation/removal
of reusable housing assembly 802 on charger 2600. For example, the weight
added by plate 2648 may allow charger to be tilted rearwardly between
about 15-30 degrees without tipping over. The degree of rearward tilt
achievable before charger 2600 tips over may vary depending upon, for
example, the weight of plate 2648, weight distribution, center of
gravity, and the like, and may be varied according to design criteria.
[0493] Bottom cover 2654 may be coupled to top cover 2606 and/or
intermediate tray 2646 via suitable fastening means, including, but not
limited to, screws that may be secured to one or more of plate 2648, top
cover 2606, and/or intermediate tray 2646. In an embodiment in which
bottom cover 2654 may be coupled via screws, foot pads 2656, 2658 may be
disposed over the screws and/or screw recesses of bottom cover 2654
(FIGS. 144-145). Additionally, foot pads 2656, 2658 may include a
relatively high friction material (e.g., urethane foam or elastomer,
rubber, or the like) that may increase the slip resistance of charger
2600 relative to a surface upon which charger 2600 is disposed. Further,
bottom cover 2654 may include opening 2660 that may allow access to reset
button 2662, e.g., which may be disposed on printed circuit board 2636.
[0494] According to one embodiment, charger 2600 may utilize a mini-USB
connection, e.g., which may provide power to charger 2600 as well as
allowing data communication, e.g., between charger 2600 and an external
computer (such as a personal computer, or the like). In some embodiments,
charger 2600 may utilize a modified mini-USB connection, e.g., which may
have the square table of the mini-USB-A plug removed to facilitate
extraction of the plug from charger 2600. Accordingly, charger 2600 may
allow for the charging of batteries associated with reusable housing
assembly 802 and/or remote control assembly 2602, as well as
communication between remote control assembly 2602, reusable housing
assembly 802, and an external computer. Such communication may allow for,
for example, downloading of logs from reusable housing assembly 802
(e.g., which may be transmitted via the internet, or other communication
network, to a customer support service), reprogramming (e.g., upgrading
software, conducting diagnostics, changing program attributes, etc.) of
reusable housing assembly 802 and/or remote control assembly 2602.
[0495] Charger 2600 may include one or more status indicators (such as
LEDs) that may indicate a charging status (e.g., charging in process,
charging complete), as well as one or more fault conditions. For example,
a red and a green LED may be utilized in connection with one or both of
reusable housing assembly 802 and remote control assembly 2602. The red
and green LED may be visually perceptible through top cover 2606 of
charger, via a thinned region of top cover 2606, one or more openings in
top cover 2606, or the like. For example, in one embodiment, a
continuously glowing red LED may indicate that the reusable housing
assembly is currently being charged. A continuously glowing green LED may
indicate that the reusable housing assembly is completely charged. A
blinking red LED may indicate a fault condition that may require user
intervention. In addition to the blinking red LED, in some embodiments,
the exact nature of the fault condition may be displayed on a display
screen associated with the remote control assembly. The absence of the
red and the green LED being illuminated may indicate that no device is
coupled (or is not properly coupled) to charger 2600. Various
additional/alternative status indicator arrangements may be implemented
depending upon design criteria and user preference. In some embodiments,
charger 2600 may include one LED as a status indicator for reusable
housing assembly 802 and remote control assembly 2602 may itself indicate
status via a screen of/associated with remote control assembly 2602 or
other status indicators on remote control assembly 2602. Such other
status indicators may include, but are note limited to, alarms (e.g.,
audio and/or vibration) and/or one or more LEDs.
[0496] In addition to the status indicators, which may indicate charging
status and the occurrence of a fault condition, charger 2600 may include
one or more overvoltage protection circuitry. In an embodiment, charger
2600 may include input overvoltage protection circuitry, which may
actuate (e.g., via opening the circuit, etc.) in the event that the
voltage provided by the USB connection is greater than a predetermined
threshold. Additionally/alternatively, charger 2600 may include output
overvoltage protection circuitry, which may actuate (e.g., via opening
the circuit, etc.) in the event that the voltage provide to the reusable
housing assembly and/or the remote control assembly is greater than a
predetermined threshold. Additionally, the battery of the reusable
housing assembly and/or of the remote control assembly may include an
overvoltage protection, e.g., which may prevent battery damage resulting
from an overvoltage event at the battery, which may not be prevented by
either the input overvoltage protection circuitry or the output
overvoltage protection circuitry. According to an embodiment, the
overvoltage protection circuitry may be hardware based, i.e., may not
rely upon software. As such, the overvoltage protection circuitry may
provide a higher level of safety, as it may not be subject to software
faults. Additionally, according to one embodiment, the occurrence of an
overvoltage event may trigger a fault condition indicator (e.g., a
blinking LED, or the like).
[0497] As shown, e.g., in FIG. 134, charger 2600 may utilize a six contact
electrical connector (e.g., electrical contacts 2612). According to an
embodiment, the six contact electrical connector may allow for power
transfer between charger 2600 and reusable housing assembly 802.
Additionally, the six contact electrical connector may allow connection
between a battery thermister and charging circuitry (e.g., which may
allow charging to be discontinued and/or provide a fault condition
indication in the event that the battery temperature is out of range).
Further, the six contact electrical connector may provide for two-way
communication between reusable housing assembly 802 and charger 2600 (as
well as between reusable housing assembly 802 and an external computer
via charger 2600). The two-way communication may allow for, for example,
reprogramming of reusable housing assembly 802 (e.g., to upgrade
software), obtaining data from reusable housing assembly 802 (e.g., such
as log information to be sent to customer service center), or the like.
The six contact electrical connector may also allow reusable housing
assembly 802 (e.g., circuitry within the reusable housing assembly) to be
reset, either as a result of a reset signal originating from an external
computer, or as a result of reset button 2662 being actuated. Resetting
reusable housing assembly 802 may be utilized for certain functions, such
as programming reusable housing assembly, diagnostic purposes, resetting
a malfunctioning reusable housing assembly, or the like. Additionally,
the six contact electrical connector may allow charger 2600 to recognize
that a reusable housing assembly has been coupled to charger 2600.
Similarly, the six contact electrical connector may allow reusable
housing assembly 802 to recognize that it has been coupled to charger
2600. The ability of reusable housing assembly 802 to recognize that it
has been coupled to charger 2600 may allow, for example, reusable housing
assembly 802 to enter a low power state while charger, initiate download
of logs, or the like. While the various features of the electrical
connection between charger 2600 and reusable housing assembly 802 have
been described, it will be appreciated that similar electrical
connections may be utilized between charger 2600 and remote control
assembly 2602. Additionally, while the use of a six contact electrical
connector has been discussed, this is for exemplary purposes only, as the
number and nature of electrical contacts and associated features may vary
depending upon user need and design criteria.
[0498] According to one embodiment, the electronics of charger 2600 may
include a commercially available charging circuit, such as a model L6924D
Battery Charger System with Integrated Power Switch for Li-Ion/Li-Polymer
(detailed in Appendix A), available from STMicroelectronics of Geneva,
Switzerland. Various other battery charging circuits may be utilized
depending upon, for example, battery characteristics, design criteria, or
the like. The battery charging circuit may, for example, monitor battery
voltage and temperature (e.g., via information provided by the battery
thermister via the six contact electrical connector). Additionally, the
battery charging circuit may adjust the battery charging parameters based
upon, for example, the battery voltage, battery temperature,
predetermined charging requirements (e.g., desired charge time, etc.) or
the like.
[0499] In addition to the charging circuit, the electronics of charger
2600 may additionally include one or more processors (example of which
may include, but is not limited to an MSP430 microcontroller, available
from Texas Instruments Inc. of Dallas, Tex.) that may control charger
2600, as well as provide for communication between an external computer
and reusable housing assembly 802 and/or remote control assembly 2602.
The one or more microprocessors may control the overall operation of
charger 2600. For example, the microprocessor may allow communication
between reusable housing assembly 802 and an external computer.
Similarly, the microprocessor may control the operation of the status
indicators (e.g., the LEDs). Various additional/alternative operations
and features of charger 2600 may be controlled by the microprocessor.
[0500] Referring also to FIGS. 146-148, exemplary charger circuitry that
may be utilized in connection with charger 2600 is schematically
illustrated. The illustrated charger circuitry is intended of
illustrative purposes only, as the exact configuration may vary depending
upon included features (status indicators, overvoltage protection, and
the like), as well the charging circuit and microcontroller utilized.
[0501] Referring also to FIGS. 149A-173G various features and embodiments
of chargers that may be utilized in connection with the reusable housing
assembly and/or remote control assembly are depicted. Any of the depicted
chargers may incorporate one or more of the above-described features.
[0502] Infusion pump therapy may include volume and time specifications.
The amount of fluid dispensed together with the dispense timing may be
two critical factors of infusion pump therapy. As discussed in detail
below, the infusion pump apparatus and systems described herein may
provide for a method of dispensing fluid together with a device, system
and method for measuring the amount of fluid dispensed. However, in a
circumstance where the calibration and precision of the measurement
device calibration is critical, there may be advantages to determining
any compromise in the precision of the measurement device as soon as
possible. Thus, there are advantages to off-board verification of volume
and pumping.
[0503] As discussed above, infusion pump assembly 100 may include volume
sensor assembly 148 configured to monitor the amount of fluid infused by
infusion pump assembly 100. Further and as discussed above, infusion pump
assembly 100 may be configured so that the volume measurements produced
by volume sensor assembly 148 may be used to control, through a feedback
loop, the amount of infusible fluid that is infused into the user.
[0504] Referring also to FIGS. 90A-90C, there is shown one diagrammatic
view and two cross-sectional views of volume sensor assembly 148.
Referring also to FIGS. 91A-91I, there is shown various isometric and
diagrammatic views of volume sensor assembly 148 (which is shown to
include upper housing 1400). Referring also to FIGS. 92A-92I, there is
shown various isometric and diagrammatic views of volume sensor assembly
148 (with upper housing 1400 removed), exposing speaker assembly 622,
reference microphone 626, and printed circuit board assembly 830.
Referring also to FIGS. 93A-93I, there is shown various isometric and
diagrammatic views of volume sensor assembly 148 (with printed circuit
board assembly 830 removed), exposing port assembly 624. Referring also
to FIGS. 94A-94F, there is shown various isometric and diagrammatic
cross-sectional views of volume sensor assembly 148 (with printed circuit
board assembly 830 removed), exposing port assembly 624. Referring also
to FIG. 95, there are shown an exploded view of volume sensor assembly
148, exposing upper housing 1400, speaker assembly 622, reference
microphone 626, seal assembly 1404, lower housing 1402, port assembly
624, spring diaphragm 628, and retaining ring assembly 1406.
[0505] The following discussion concerns the design and operation of
volume sensor assembly 148 (which is shown in a simplified form in FIG.
96). For the following discussion, the following nomenclature may be
used:
TABLE-US-00009
Symbols
P Pressure
p Pressure Perturbation
V Volume
v Volume Perturbation
.gamma. Specific Heat Ratio
R Gas Constant
.rho. Density
Z Impedance
f Flow friction
A Cross sectional Area
L Length
.omega. Frequency
.zeta. Damping ratio
.alpha. Volume Ratio
Subscripts
0 Speaker Volume
1 Reference Volume
2 Variable Volume
k Speaker
r Resonant Port
z Zero
p Pole
Derivation of the Equations for Volume Sensor Assembly 148:
Modeling the Acoustic Volumes
[0506] The pressure and volume of an ideal adiabatic gas may be related
by:
PV.sup..gamma.=K [EQ#1]
[0507] where K is a constant defined by the initial conditions of the
system.
[0508] EQ#1 may be written in terms of a mean pressure, P, and volume, V,
and a small time-dependent perturbation on top of those pressures, p(t),
v(t) as follows:
(P+p(t))(V+v(t)).sup..gamma.=K [EQ#2]
[0509] Differentiating this equation may result in:
{dot over
(p)}(t)(V+v(t)).sup..gamma.+.gamma.(V+v(t)).sup..gamma.-1(P+p(t)){dot
over (v)}(t)=0 [EQ#3]
[0510] which may simplify to:
p . ( t ) + .gamma. P + p ( t ) V + v ( t )
v . ( t ) = 0 [ EQ #4 ] ##EQU00001##
[0511] If the acoustic pressure levels are much less than the ambient
pressure, the equation may be further simplified to:
p . ( t ) + .gamma. P V v . ( t ) =
0 [ EQ #5 ] ##EQU00002##
[0512] How good is this assumption? Using the adiabatic relation it may be
shown that:
P V = ( P + p ( t ) V + v ( t ) ) ( P +
p ( t ) P ) - .gamma. + 1 .gamma. [ EQ #6 ]
##EQU00003##
[0513] Accordingly, the error in the assumption would be:
error = 1 - ( P + p ( t ) P ) - .gamma. + 1 .gamma.
[ EQ #7 ] ##EQU00004##
[0514] A very loud acoustic signal (120 dB) may correspond to pressure
sine wave with amplitude of roughly 20 Pascal. Assuming air at
atmospheric conditions (.gamma.=1.4, P=101325 Pa), the resulting error is
0.03%. The conversion from dB to Pa is as follows:
.lamda. = 20 log 10 ( p rms p ref ) or
p rms = p ref 10 .lamda. 20 [ EQ #8 ]
##EQU00005##
[0515] where p.sub.ref=20.mu.Pa.
[0516] Applying the ideal gas law, P=.rho.RT, and substituting in for
pressure may result in the following:
p . ( t ) + .gamma. RT .rho. V v .
( t ) = 0 [ EQ #9 ] ##EQU00006##
[0517] EQ#9 may be written in terms of the speed of sound, a= {square root
over (.gamma.RT)} as follows:
p . ( t ) + .rho. a 2 V v . ( t
) = 0 [ EQ #10 ] ##EQU00007##
[0518] Acoustic impedance for a volume may be defined as follows:
Z v = p ( t ) v . ( t ) = - 1 ( V .rho.
a 2 ) s [ EQ #11 ] ##EQU00008##
[0519] Modeling the Acoustic Port
[0520] The acoustic port may be modeled assuming that all of the fluid in
the port essentially moves as a rigid cylinder reciprocating in the axial
direction. All of the fluid in the channel is assumed to travel at the
same velocity, the channel is assumed to be of constant cross section,
and the "end effects" resulting from the fluid entering and leaving the
channel are neglected.
[0521] If we assume laminar flow friction of the form .DELTA.p=f .rho.{dot
over (v)}, the friction force acting on the mass of fluid in the channel
may be written as follows:
F=f.rho.A.sup.2{dot over (x)} [EQ#12]
[0522] A second order differential equation may then be written for the
dynamics of the fluid in the channel:
.rho.LA{umlaut over (x)}=.DELTA.pA-f.rho.A.sup.2{dot over (x)} [EQ#13]
[0523] or, in terms of volume flow rate:
v = - f A L v . + .DELTA. p A
.rho. L [ EQ #14 ] ##EQU00009##
[0524] The acoustic impedance of the channel may then be written as
follows:
Z p = .DELTA. p v . = .rho. L A ( s +
f A L ) [ EQ #15 ] ##EQU00010##
[0525] System Transfer Functions
[0526] Using the volume and port dynamics defined above, volume sensor
assembly 148 may be described by the following system of equations:
(k=speaker, r=resonator)
p . 0 - .rho. a 2 V 0 v . k = 0 [
EQ #16 ] p . 1 + .rho. a 2 V 1 (
v . k - v . r ) = 0 [ EQ #17 ] p . 2 +
.rho. a 2 V 2 v . r = 0 [ EQ #18 ]
v r = - f A L v . r + A .rho. L
( p 2 - p 1 ) [ EQ #19 ] ##EQU00011##
[0527] One equation may be eliminated if p.sub.0 is treated as the input
substituting in
v . k = V 0 .rho. a 2 p . 0 .
p . 1 + V 0 V 1 p . 0 - .rho. a 2 V 1
v . r = 0 [ EQ #20 ] p . 2 + .rho. a
2 V 2 v . r = 0 [ EQ #21 ] v r = - fA
L v . r + A .rho. L p 2 - A .rho. L
p 1 [ EQ #22 ] ##EQU00012##
[0528] Cross System Transfer Function
[0529] The relationship between the speaker volume and the variable volume
may be referred to as the Cross System transfer function. This transfer
function may be derived from the above equations and is as follows:
p 2 p 0 = - V 0 V 1 .omega. n 2 s 2 + 2
.zeta..omega. n s + .alpha..omega. n 2 [ EQ #23 ]
where .omega. n 2 = a 2 A L 1 V 2 , .zeta.
= fA 2 L .omega. n and .alpha. = ( a +
V 2 V 1 ) [ EQ #24 ] ##EQU00013##
[0530] Referring also to FIG. 97, a bode plot of EQ#23 is shown.
[0531] The difficulty of this relationship is that the complex poles
depend on both the variable volume, V.sub.2, and the reference volume,
V.sub.1. Any change in the mean position of the speaker may result in an
error in the estimated volume.
[0532] Cross Port Transfer Function
[0533] The relationship between the two volumes on each side of the
acoustic port may be referred to as the Cross Port transfer function.
This relationship is as follows:
p 2 p 1 = .omega. n 2 s 2 + 2 .zeta..omega. n s +
.omega. n 2 [ EQ #25 ] ##EQU00014##
[0534] which is shown graphically in FIG. 98.
[0535] This relationship has the advantage that the poles are only
dependent on the variable volume and not on the reference volume. It
does, however, have the difficulty that the resonant peak is actually due
to the inversion of the zero in the response of the reference volume
pressure. Accordingly, the pressure measurement in the reference chamber
will have a low amplitude in the vicinity of the resonance, potentially
increasing the noise in the measurement.
[0536] Cross Speaker Transfer Function
[0537] The pressures may also be measured on each side of the speaker.
This is referred to as the cross speaker transfer function:
p 1 p 0 = - V 0 V 1 s 2 + 2 .zeta..omega. n
s + .omega. n 2 s 2 + 2 .zeta..omega. n s +
.alpha..omega. n 2 [ EQ #26 ] ##EQU00015##
[0538] which is shown graphically in FIG. 99.
[0539] This transfer function has a set of complex zeros in addition to
the set of complex poles.
[0540] Looking at the limits of this transfer function: as
s -> 0 , p 1 p 0 -> - V 0 V 1 + V 2 ;
##EQU00016##
and as
s -> .infin. , p 1 p 0 -> - V 0 V 1 .
##EQU00017##
[0541] Resonance Q Factor and Peak Response
[0542] The quality of the resonance is the ratio of the energy stored to
the power loss multiplied by the resonant frequency. For a pure
second-order system, the quality factor may be expressed as a function of
the damping ratio:
Q = 1 2 .zeta. [ EQ #27 ] ##EQU00018##
[0543] The ratio of the peak response to the low-frequency response may
also be written as a function of the damping ratio:
G .omega. d = 1 .zeta. 5 - 4 .zeta. [ EQ
#28 ] ##EQU00019##
[0544] This may occur at the damped natural frequency:
.omega..sub.d=.omega..sub.n {square root over (1-.zeta.)} [EQ#29]
[0545] Volume Estimation
[0546] Volume Estimation Using Cross-Port Phase
[0547] The variable volume (i.e., within volume sensor chamber 620) may
also be estimated using the cross-port phase. The transfer function for
the pressure ratio across the resonant port may be as follows:
p 2 p 1 = .omega. n 2 s 2 + bs + .omega. n 2 [
EQ #30 ] ##EQU00020##
[0548] At the 90.degree. phase point, .omega.=.omega..sub.n; where
.omega. n 2 = 1 V 2 a 2 A L ##EQU00021##
[0549] The resonant frequency may be found on the physical system using a
number of methods. A phase-lock loop may be employed to find the
90.degree. phase point--this frequency may correspond to the natural
frequency of the system. Alternatively, the resonant frequency may be
calculated using the phase at any two frequencies:
[0550] The phase, .PHI., at any given frequency will satisfy the following
relation:
tan .phi. = b .omega. .omega. 2 - .omega. n
2 where b = fA L . [ EQ #31 ]
##EQU00022##
[0551] Solving for V.sub.2 results in:
V 2 = a 2 A L .omega. 2 - f .omega. cot
.phi. [ EQ #32 ] ##EQU00023##
[0552] Accordingly, the ratio of the phases at two different frequencies
.omega..sub.1 and .omega..sub.2 can be used to compute the natural
frequency of the system:
.alpha..omega. n 2 = .omega. 1 .omega. 2 ( .omega. 1
tan .phi. 1 tan .phi. 2 - .omega. 2 ) (
.omega. 2 tan .phi. 1 tan .phi. 2 - .omega.
1 ) [ EQ #33 ] ##EQU00024##
[0553] For computational efficiency, the actual phase does not need to be
calculated. All that is needed is the ratio of the real and imaginary
parts of the response (tan .PHI.).
[0554] Re-writing EQ#33 in terms of the variable volume results in:
1 V 1 = 1 a 2 L A .omega. 1 .omega. 2 (
.omega. 1 tan .phi. 1 tan .phi. 2 - .omega.
2 ) ( .omega. 2 tan .phi. 1 tan .phi. 2
- .omega. 1 ) [ EQ #34 ] ##EQU00025##
[0555] Volume Estimation Using Swept Sine
[0556] The resonant frequency of the system may be estimated using
swept-sine system identification. In this method, the response of the
system to a sinusoidal pressure variation may be found at a number of
different frequencies. This frequency response data may then used to
estimate the system transfer function using linear regression.
[0557] The transfer function for the system may be expressed as a rational
function of s. The general case is expressed below for a transfer
function with an n.sup.th order numerator and an m.sup.th order
denominator. N and D are the coefficients for the numerator and
denominator respectively. The equation has been normalized such that the
leading coefficient in the denominator is 1.
G ( s ) = N n s n + N n - 1 s n - 1 + +
N 0 s m + D m - 1 s m - 1 + D m - 2 s m - 2
+ + D 0 [ EQ #35 ] or G ( s ) = k
= 0 n N k s k s m + k = 0 m - 1 D k s k
[ EQ #36 ] ##EQU00026##
[0558] This equation may be re-written as follows:
Gs m = k = 0 n N k s k - G k = 0 m - 1
D k s k [ EQ #37 ] ##EQU00027##
[0559] Representing this summation in matrix notation resulting in the
following:
[ G 1 s 1 m G k s k m ] = [ s
1 n s 1 0 - G 1 s 1 m - 1 - G 1 s 1 0
s k n s k 0 - G k s k m
- 1 - G k s k 0 ] [ N n N 0
D m - 1 D 0 ] [ EQ #38 ] ##EQU00028##
[0560] where k is the number of data points collected in the swept sine.
To simplify the notation, this equation may be summarized using the
vectors:
y=Xc [EQ#39]
[0561] where y is k by 1, x is k by (m+n-1) and c is (m+n-1) by 1. The
coefficients may then be found using a least square approach. The error
function may be written as follows:
e=y-Xc [EQ#40]
[0562] The function to be minimized is the weighted square of the error
function; W is a k.times.k diagonal matrix.
e.sup.TWe=(y-Xc).sup.TW(y-Xc) [EQ#41]
e.sup.TWe=y.sup.TWy-(y.sup.TWXc).sup.T-y.sup.TWXc+c.sup.Tx.sup.TWXc
[EQ#42]
[0563] As the center two terms are scalars, the transpose may be
neglected.
e T We = y T Wy - 2 y T WXc + c T x T
WXc [ EQ #43 ] .differential. e T We
.differential. c = - 2 X T Wy + 2 X T WXc = 0
[ EQ #44 ] c = ( X T WX ) - 1 X T Wy [
EQ #45 ] ##EQU00029##
[0564] It may be necessary to use the complex transpose in all of these
cases. This approach may result in complex coefficients, but the process
may be modified to ensure that all the coefficients are real. The
least-square minimization may be modified to give only real coefficients
if the error function is changed to be
e.sup.TWe=Re(y-Xc).sup.TWRe(y-Xc)+Im(y-Xc).sup.TWIm(y-Xc) [EQ#46]
[0565] Accordingly, the coefficients may be found with the relation:
c=(Re(X).sup.TWRe(X)+Im(X).sup.TWIm(X)).sup.-1(Re(X).sup.TWRe(y)+Im(X).s-
up.TWIm(y)) [EQ#47]
[0566] Solution for a 2nd Order System
[0567] For a system with a 0.sup.th order numerator and a second order
denominator as shown in the transfer function:
( G ) s = N 0 s 2 + D 1 s + D 0 [ EQ #48
] ##EQU00030##
[0568] The coefficients in this transfer function may be found based on
the expression found in the previous section:
c=(Re(X).sup.TWRe(X)+Im(X).sup.TWIm(X)).sup.-1(Re(X).sup.TWRe(y)+Im(X).s-
up.TWIm(y)) [EQ#49]
[0569] where:
y = [ G 1 s 1 2 G k s k 2 ] , X =
[ 1 - G 1 s 1 - G 1 1 - G k
s k - G k ] , and c = [ N 0 D 1
D 0 ] [ EQ #50 ] ##EQU00031##
[0570] To simplify the algorithm, we may combine some of terms:
c=D.sup.-1b [EQ#51]
where:
D=Re(X).sup.TWRe(X)+Im(X).sup.TWIm(X) [EQ#52]
b=Re(X).sup.TRe(y)+Im(X).sup.TIm(y) [EQ#53]
[0571] To find an expression for D in terms of the complex response vector
G and the natural frequency s=j.omega., X may be split into its real and
imaginary parts:
Re ( X ) = [ 1 .omega. k Im ( G 1 ) -
Re ( G 1 ) 1 .omega. k Im ( G k )
- Re ( G k ) ] , Im ( X ) = [ 0 -
.omega. k Re ( G 1 ) - Im ( G 1 )
0 - .omega. k Re ( G k ) - Im ( G k ) ]
[ EQ #54 ] ##EQU00032##
[0572] The real and imaginary portions of the expression for D above may
then become:
Re ( X ) T W Re ( X ) = [ i = 1 k
w i i = 1 k w i Im ( G i ) .omega. i
- i = 1 k w i Re ( G i ) i = 1 k w
i Im ( G i ) .omega. i i = 1 k w i Im
( G i ) 2 .omega. i 2 - i = 1 k w i Im (
G i ) Re ( G i ) .omega. i - i = 1 k w
i Re ( G i ) - i = 1 k w i Im ( G i )
Re ( G i ) .omega. i i = 1 k w i Re
( G i ) 2 ] [ EQ #55 ] Im ( X ) T W
Im ( X ) = [ 0 0 0 0 i = 1 k w i
Re ( G i ) 2 .omega. i 2 i = 1 k w i Im
( G i ) Re ( G i ) .omega. i 0 i = 1 k
w i Im ( G i ) Re ( G i ) .omega. i i =
1 k w i Im ( G i ) 2 ] [ EQ #56 ]
##EQU00033##
[0573] Combining these terms results in the final expression for the D
matrix, which may contain only real values.
D = [ i = 1 k w i i = 1 k w i Im (
G i ) .omega. i - i = 1 k w i Re ( G i )
i = 1 k w i Im ( G i ) .omega. i
i = 1 k w i ( Re ( G i ) 2 + Im ( G i ) 2
) .omega. i 2 0 - i = 1 k w i Re ( G i
) 0 i = 1 k w i ( Re ( G i ) 2 + Im
( G i ) 2 ) ] [ EQ #57 ] ##EQU00034##
[0574] The same approach may be taken to find an expression for the b
vector in terms of G and .omega.. The real and imaginary parts of y are
as follows:
Re ( y ) = [ - Re ( G 1 ) .omega. 1 2
- Re ( G k ) .omega. k 2 ] , Im ( y ) =
[ - Im ( G 1 ) .omega. 1 2 - Im ( G k
) .omega. k 2 ] [ EQ #58 ] ##EQU00035##
[0575] Combining the real and imaginary parts results in the expression
for the b vector as follows:
b = Re ( X ) T W Re ( y ) + Im ( X )
T W Im ( y ) = [ - i = 1 k w i
Re ( G i ) .omega. i 2 0 i = 1 k w i
( Re ( G i ) 2 + Im ( G i ) 2 ) .omega. i 2
] [ EQ #59 ] ##EQU00036##
[0576] The next step is to invert the D matrix. The matrix is symmetric
and positive-definite so the number of computations needed to find the
inverse will be reduced from the general 3.times.3 case. The general
expression for a matrix inverse is:
D - 1 = 1 det ( D ) adj ( D ) [ EQ #60
] ##EQU00037##
[0577] If D is expressed as follows:
D = [ d 11 d 12 d 13 d 12 d 22 0 d 13
0 d 33 ] [ EQ #61 ] ##EQU00038##
[0578] then the adjugate matrix may be written as follows:
adj ( D ) = [ d 22 0 0 d 33 -
d 12 0 d 13 d 33 d 12 d 22 d 13
0 - d 12 d 13 0 d 33 d 11
d 13 d 13 d 33 - d 11 d 12 d 13 0
d 12 d 13 d 22 0 - d 11 d 13
d 12 0 d 11 d 12 d 12 d 22
] = [ a 11 a 12 a 13 a 12 a 22 a 23
a 13 a 32 a 33 ] [ EQ #62 ] ##EQU00039##
[0579] Due to symmetry, only the upper diagonal matrix may need to be
calculated.
[0580] The Determinant may then be computed in terms of the adjugate
matrix values, taking advantage of the zero elements in the original
array:
det(D)=a.sub.12d.sub.12+a.sub.22d.sub.22 [EQ#63]
[0581] Finally, the inverse of D may be written as follows:
D - 1 = 1 det ( D ) adj ( D ) [ EQ #64
] ##EQU00040##
[0582] Since we are trying to solve:
c = D - 1 b = 1 det ( D ) adj ( D ) b
[ EQ #65 ] ##EQU00041##
[0583] then:
[ EQ #66 ] ##EQU00042## c = 1 det ( D ) [
a 11 a 12 a 13 a 12 a 22 a 23 a 13 a 32
a 33 ] [ b 1 0 b 3 ] = 1 det ( D )
[ a 11 b 1 + a 13 b 3 a 12 b 1 +
a 23 b 3 a 13 b 1 + a 33 b 3 ]
##EQU00042.2##
[0584] The final step is to get a quantitative assessment of how well the
data fits the model. Accordingly, the original expression for the error
is as follows:
e.sup.TWe=Re(y-Xc).sup.TWRe(y-Xc)+Im(y-Xc).sup.TWIm(y-Xc) [EQ#67]
[0585] This may be expressed in terms of the D matrix and the b and c
vectors as follows:
e.sup.TWe=h-2c.sup.Tb+c.sup.TDc [EQ#68]
[0586] where:
h = Re ( y T ) W Re ( y ) + Im ( y T
) W Im ( y ) [ EQ #69 ] h = i = 1 k
w i ( Re ( G i ) 2 + Im ( G i ) 2 )
.omega. i 4 [ EQ #70 ] ##EQU00043##
[0587] The model fit error may also be used to detect sensor failures.
[0588] Alternate Solution for a 2nd Order System
G ( s ) = N n s n + N n - 1 s n - 1 + +
N 0 s m + D m - 1 s m - 1 + D m - 2 s m - 2
+ + D 0 [ EQ #71 ] or G ( s ) = k
= 0 n N k s k s m + k = 0 m - 1 D k
s k [ EQ #72 ] ##EQU00044##
[0589] This equation may be re-written as follows:
G = k = 0 n N k s k - m - G k = 0 m
- 1 D k s k - m [ EQ #73 ] ##EQU00045##
[0590] Putting this summation into matrix notation results in the
following:
[ G 1 G k ] = [ s 1 n - m s 1 -
m - G 1 s 1 - 1 - G 1 s 1 - m
s k n - m s k - m - G k s k - 1
- G k s k - m ] [ N n N 0
D m - 1 D 0 ] [ EQ #74 ] ##EQU00046##
[0591] For a system with a 0.sup.th order numerator and a second order
denominator as shown in the transfer function:
G ( s ) = N 0 s 2 + D 1 s + D 0 [ EQ #75
] ##EQU00047##
[0592] The coefficients in this transfer function may be found based on
the expression found in the previous section:
c=(Re(X).sup.TWRe(X)+Im(X).sup.TWIm(X)).sup.-1(Re(X).sup.TWRe(y)+Im(X).s-
up.TWIm(y)) [EQ#76]
[0593] where
y = [ G 1 G k ] , X = [ s 1 - 2 -
G 1 s 1 - 1 - G 1 s 1 - 2 s k -
2 - G k s k - 1 - G k s k - 2 ] ,
and c = [ N 0 D 1 D 0 ] [ EQ #77 ]
##EQU00048##
[0594] To simplify the algorithm, some terms may be combined:
c=D.sup.-1b [EQ#78]
where:
D=Re(X).sup.TWRe(X)+Im(X).sup.TWIm(X) [EQ#79]
b=Re(X).sup.TRe(y)+Im(X).sup.TIm(y) [EQ#80]
[0595] To find an expression for D in terms of the complex response vector
G and the natural frequency s=j.omega., split X may be split into its
real and imaginary parts:
Re ( X ) = [ - .omega. 1 - 2 - .omega. 1 - 1
Im ( G 1 ) .omega. 1 - 2 Re ( G 1 )
- .omega. k - 2 - .omega. k - 1 Im ( G k )
.omega. k - 2 Re ( G k ) ] [ EQ #81 ]
Im ( X ) = [ 0 - .omega. 1 - 1 Re ( G 1 )
.omega. 1 - 2 Im ( G 1 ) 0 - .omega.
k - 1 Re ( G k ) .omega. k - 2 Im ( G k )
] [ EQ #82 ] ##EQU00049##
[0596] The real and imaginary portions of the expression for D above may
then become:
[ EQ #83 ] Re ( X ) T W Re (
X ) = [ i = 1 k w i .omega. i - 4
i = 1 k w i Im ( G i ) .omega. i - 3
- i = 1 k w i Re ( G i ) .omega. i - 4
i = 1 k w i Im ( G i ) .omega. i - 3
i = 1 k w i Im ( G i ) 2 .omega. i -
2 - i = 1 k w i Im ( G i ) Re ( G
i ) .omega. i - 3 - i = 1 k w i Re
( G i ) .omega. i - 4 - i = 1 k w i Im
( G i ) Re ( G i ) .omega. i - 3 i = 1 k
w i Re ( G i ) 2 .omega. i - 4 ]
[ EQ #84 ] Im ( X ) T W Im ( X )
= [ 0 0 0 0 i = 1 k w i Re ( G i
) 2 .omega. i - 2 - i = 1 k w i Im (
G i ) Re ( G i ) .omega. i - 3 0 - i =
1 k w i Im ( G i ) Re ( G i ) .omega.
i - 3 i = 1 k w i Im ( G i ) 2
.omega. i - 4 ] ##EQU00050##
[0597] Combining these terms results in the final expression for the D
matrix, which may contain only real values.
[ EQ #85 ] ##EQU00051## D = [ i = 1 k
w i .omega. i - 4 i = 1 k w i Im
( G i ) .omega. i - 3 - i = 1 k w i Re
( G i ) .omega. i - 4 i = 1 k w i
Im ( G i ) .omega. i - 3 i = 1 k w i
( Re ( G i ) 2 + Im ( G i ) 2 ) .omega. i - 2
- 2 i = 1 k w i Im ( G i ) Re
( G i ) .omega. i - 3 - i = 1 k w i
Re ( G i ) .omega. i - 4 - 2 i = 1 k
w i Im ( G i ) Re ( G i ) .omega. i - 3
i = 1 k w i ( Re ( G i ) 2 + Im ( G i
) 2 ) .omega. i - 4 ] ##EQU00051.2##
[0598] The same approach may be taken to find an expression for the b
vector in terms of G and .omega.. The real and imaginary parts of y areas
follows:
Re ( y ) = [ - Re ( G 1 ) - Re (
G k ) ] , Im ( y ) = [ - Im ( G 1 )
- Im ( G k ) ] [ EQ #86 ] ##EQU00052##
[0599] Combining the real and imaginary parts results in the expression
for the b vector as follows:
b = Re ( X ) T W Re ( y ) + Im ( X )
T W Im ( y ) = [ - i = 1 k w i
Re ( G i ) .omega. i - 2 - i = 1 k
w i ( Im ( G i ) + Re ( G i ) .omega. i - 1
i = 1 k w i ( Re ( G i ) 2 + Im (
G i ) 2 ) .omega. i - 2 ] [ EQ #87 ]
##EQU00053##
[0600] Implementing Acoustic Volume Sensing
[0601] Collecting the Frequency Response Data and Computing the Complex
Response
[0602] To implement volume sensor assembly 148, volume sensor assembly 148
should determine the relative response of reference microphone 626 and
invariable volume microphone 630 to the acoustic wave set up by speaker
assembly 622. This may be accomplished by driving speaker assembly 622
with a sinusoidal output at a known frequency; the complex response of
microphones 626, 630 may then be found at that driving frequency.
Finally, the relative response of microphones 626, 630 may be found and
corrected for alternating sampling by e.g., an analog-to-digital
convertor (i.e., ADC).
[0603] Additionally, the total signal variance may be computed and
compared to the variance of pure tone extracted using the discrete
Fourier transform (i.e., DFT). This may result in a measure of how much
of the signal power comes from noise sources or distortion. This value
may then be used to reject and repeat bad measurements.
[0604] Computing the Discrete Fourier Transform
[0605] The signal from the microphone may be sampled synchronously with
the output to speaker assembly 622 such that a fixed number of points, N,
are taken per wavelength. The measured signal at each point in the
wavelength may be summed over an integer number of wavelengths, M, and
stored in an array x by the ISR for processing after all the data for
that frequency has been collected.
[0606] A DFT may be performed on the data at the integer value
corresponding to the driven frequency of the speaker. The general
expression for the first harmonic of a DFT is as follows:
x k = 2 MN n = 0 N - 1 x n e - 2
.pi. i N kn [ EQ #88 ] ##EQU00054##
[0607] The product MN may be the total number of points and the factor of
two may be added such that the resulting real and imaginary portions of
the answer match the amplitude of the sine wave:
x n = re ( x k ) cos ( 2 .pi. N kn ) +
im ( x k ) sin ( 2 .pi. N kn ) [ EQ
#89 ] ##EQU00055##
[0608] This real part of this expression may be as follows:
re ( x ) = 2 MN n = 0 N - 1 x n cos
( 2 .pi. N n ) [ EQ #90 ] ##EQU00056##
[0609] We may take advantage of the symmetry of the cosine function to
reduce the number of computations needed to compute the DFT. The
expression above may be equivalent to:
[ EQ #91 ] ##EQU00057## re ( x ) = 2 MN [
( x 0 - x 1 2 N ) + n = 1 1 4 N - 1
sin ( .pi. 2 - 2 .pi. N n ) [ ( x n
- x 1 2 N + n ) - ( x 1 2 N + n - x N - n )
] ] ##EQU00057.2##
[0610] Similarly, for the imaginary portion of the equation:
im ( x ) = - 2 MN n = 0 N - 1 x n
sin ( 2 .pi. N n ) [ EQ #92 ] ##EQU00058##
[0611] which may be expressed as follows:
[ EQ #93 ] ##EQU00059## im ( x ) = - 2 MN [
( x 1 4 N - x 3 4 N ) + n = 1 1 4 N - 1
sin ( 2 .pi. N n ) [ ( x n - x 1 2 N
+ n ) + ( x 1 2 N + n - x N - n ) ] ]
##EQU00059.2##
[0612] The variance of this signal may be calculated as follows:
.sigma..sup.2=1/2(re(x).sup.2+im(x).sup.2) [EQ#94]
[0613] The maximum possible value of the real and imaginary portions of x
may be 2.sup.11; which corresponds to half the AD range. The maximum
value of the tone variance may be 2.sup.21; half the square of the AD
range.
[0614] Computing the Signal Variance
[0615] The pseudo-variance of the signal may be calculated using the
following relation:
.sigma. 2 = 1 NM 2 n = 0 N - 1 x n 2 -
1 N 2 M 2 ( n = 0 N - 1 x n ) 2 [
EQ #95 ] ##EQU00060##
[0616] The result may be in the units of AD counts squared. It may only be
the "pseudo-variance" because the signal has been averaged over M periods
before the variance is calculated over the N samples in the "averaged"
period. This may be a useful metric, however, for finding if the
"averaged" signal looks like a sinusoid at the expected frequency. This
may be done by comparing the total signal variance to that of the
sinusoid found in the discrete Fourier transform.
[0617] The summation may be on the order of
n = 0 N - 1 x n 2 = O ( NM 2 2 24 )
##EQU00061##
for a 12-bit ADC. If N<2.sup.7=128 and M<2.sup.6=64, then the
summation will be less than 2.sup.43 and may be stored in a 64-bit
integer. The maximum possible value of the variance may result if the ADC
oscillated between a value of 0 and 2.sup.12 on each consecutive sample.
This may result in a peak variance of 1/4(2.sup.12).sup.2=2.sup.22 so the
result may be stored at a maximum of a 1/2.sup.9 resolution in a signed
32-bit integer.
[0618] Computing the Relative Microphone Response
[0619] The relative response (G) of microphones 626, 630 may be computed
from the complex response of the individual microphones:
G = x var x ref = x var x ref x ref * x ref *
[ EQ #96 ] Re ( G ) = Re ( x var ) Re
( x ref ) + Im ( x var ) Im ( x ref ) Re
( x ref ) 2 + Im ( x ref ) 2 [ EQ #97 ]
Im ( G ) = Re ( x ref ) Im ( x var ) - Re
( x var ) Im ( x ref ) Re ( x ref ) 2 + Im
( x ref ) 2 [ EQ #98 ] ##EQU00062##
[0620] The denominator of either expression may be expressed in terms of
the reference tone variance computed in the previous section as follows:
Re(x.sub.ref).sup.2+Im(x.sub.ref).sup.2=2.sigma..sub.ref.sup.2 [EQ#99]
[0621] Correcting for A/D Skew
[0622] The signals from microphones 626, 630 may not be sampled
simultaneously; the A/D ISR alternates between microphones 626, 630,
taking a total of N samples per wavelength for each of microphones 626,
630. The result may be a phase offset between two microphones 626, 630 of
.pi. N . ##EQU00063##
To correct for this phase offset, a complex rotation may be applied to
the relative frequency response computed in the previous section:
G rotated = G ( cos ( .pi. N ) + i sin (
.pi. N ) ) [ EQ #100 ] ##EQU00064##
[0623] Reference Models
[0624] Second and Higher Order Models
[0625] Leakage through the seals (e.g., seal assembly 1404) of volume
sensor chamber 620 may be modeled as a second resonant port (e.g., port
1504, FIG. 100) connected to an external volume (e.g., external volume
1506, FIG. 100).
[0626] The system of equations describing the three-chamber configuration
may be as follows:
p . 1 + .rho. a 2 V 1 ( v . k - v .
r 12 ) = 0 [ EQ #101 ] p . 2 + .rho.
a 2 V 2 ( v . r 12 - v . r 23 )
= 0 [ EQ #102 ] v r 12 = - f 12
A 12 L 12 v . r 12 + A 12 .rho. L 12
( p 2 - p 1 ) [ EQ #103 ] p . 3 +
.rho. a 2 V 3 v . r 23 = 0 [ EQ #104
] v r 23 = - f 23 A 23 L 23 v .
r 23 + A 23 .rho. L 23 ( p 3 - p 2 )
[ EQ #105 ] ##EQU00065##
[0627] Putting these equations into state-space results in the following:
[ p . 1 p . 2 p . 3 v 12 v
23 ] = [ 0 0 0 .rho. a 2 V 1 0
0 0 0 - .rho. a 2 V 2 .rho. a 2
V 2 0 0 0 0 - .rho. a 2 V 3 - A 12
.rho. L 12 A 12 .rho. L 12 0 - b 12
0 0 - A 23 .rho. L 23 A 23 .rho. L
23 0 - b 23 ] [ p 1 p 2 p 3 v
12 v 23 ] + [ - .rho. a 2 V 1 0
0 0 0 ] [ v . k ] [ EQ #106 ]
##EQU00066##
[0628] the frequency response of which may be represented graphically in
the Bode diagram shown in FIG. 101 and which may also be written in
transfer function form:
p 2 p 1 = .omega. 12 2 ( s 2 + b 23 s +
.omega. 23 2 ) ( s 2 + b 12 s + .omega. 12 2 )
( s 2 + b 23 s + .omega. 23 2 ) + V 3 V 2
.omega. 23 2 ( s + b 12 ) s [ EQ #107 ]
##EQU00067##
[0629] Expanding the denominator results in the following:
p 2 p 1 = .omega. 12 2 ( s 2 + b 23 s +
.omega. 23 2 ) s 4 + ( b 12 + b 23 ) s 3 +
( b 12 b 23 + .omega. 12 2 + .omega. 23 2 ( 1 + V
3 V 2 ) ) s 2 + ( b 23 .omega. 12 2 + b
12 .omega. 23 2 ( 1 + V 3 V 2 ) ) s + .omega.
12 2 .omega. 23 2 [ EQ #108 ] ##EQU00068##
[0630] A bubble underneath the diaphragm material in the variable volume
will follow the same dynamic equations as a leakage path. In this case,
the diaphragm material may act as the resonant mass rather than the
leakage port. Accordingly, the equation may be as follows:
m{umlaut over (x)}=.DELTA.pA-b.sub.m{dot over (x)} [EQ#109]
[0631] wherein m is the mass of the diaphragm, A is the cross sectional
area of the diaphragm that can resonate, and b.sub.m is the mechanical
damping. EQ#106 may be written in terms of the volume flow rate:
v = - b m v . + .DELTA. p A 2 m
[ EQ #110 ] ##EQU00069##
[0632] wherein the volume of the air bubble is V3. If the bubble volume is
substantially smaller than the acoustic volume V3<<V2 than the
transfer function may be simplified to:
p 2 p 1 = .omega. 12 2 ( s 2 + b 23 s +
.omega. 23 2 ) ( s 2 + b 12 s + .omega. 12 2 ) (
s 2 + b 23 s + .omega. 23 2 ( 1 + V 3 V 2 ) )
[ EQ #111 ] ##EQU00070##
[0633] Second Order with Time Delay
[0634] The volume sensor assembly 148 equations derived above assume that
the pressure is the same everywhere in the acoustic volume. This is only
an approximation, as there are time delays associated with the
propagation of the sound waves through the volume. This situation may
look like a time delay or a time advance based on the relative position
of the microphone and speakers.
[0635] A time delay may be expressed in the Laplace domain as:
G(s)=e.sup.-.DELTA.Ts [EQ#112]
[0636] which makes for a non-linear set of equations. However, a
first-order Pade approximation of the time delay may be used as follows:
G ( s ) = - s + 2 .DELTA. T s - 2 .DELTA.
T [ EQ #113 ] ##EQU00071##
[0637] which is shown graphically in FIG. 102.
[0638] Three Chamber Volume Estimation
[0639] Volume sensor assembly 148 may also be configured using a third
reference volume (e.g., reference volume 1508; FIG. 103) connected with a
separate resonant port (e.g., port 1510; FIG. 103). This configuration
may allow for temperature-independent volume estimation.
[0640] The system of equations describing the three-chamber configuration
are as follows:
p . 1 + .rho. a 2 V 1 ( v . k - v .
r 12 - v . r 13 ) = 0 [ EQ #114 ]
p . 2 + .rho. a 2 V 2 v . r 12 = 0
[ EQ #115 ] v r 12 = - f 12 A 12
L 12 v . r 12 + A 12 .rho. L 12 (
p 2 - p 1 ) [ EQ #116 ] p . 3 + .rho.
a 2 V 3 v . r 13 = 0 [ EQ #117 ] v
r 13 = - f 13 A 13 L 13 v . r 13
+ A 13 .rho. L 13 ( p 2 - p 1 ) [ EQ
#118 ] ##EQU00072##
[0641] Using these equations and solving for the transfer function across
each of the resonant ports results in the following:
p 2 p 1 = .omega. n 12 2 s 2 + 2 .zeta. 12
.omega. n 12 s + .omega. n 12 2 [ EQ
#119 ] where .omega. n 12 = 1 V 2 a
2 A 12 L 12 and .zeta. = f 12 A 12 2
L 12 .omega. n 12 [ EQ #120 ] p 3 p 1
= .omega. n 13 2 s 2 + 2 .zeta. 13 .omega. n
13 s + .omega. n 13 2 [ EQ #121 ] where
.omega. n 13 = 1 V 3 a 2 A 13 L 13
and .zeta. = f 13 A 13 2 L 13 .omega.
n 13 [ EQ #122 ] ##EQU00073##
[0642] The volume of volume sensor chamber 620 may be estimated using the
ratio of the natural frequency of the two resonant ports as follows:
.omega. n 13 2 .omega. n 12 2 = V 2 V 3
A 13 A 12 L 12 L 13 [ EQ #123 ] ##EQU00074##
[0643] EQ#120 illustrates that the volume of volume sensor chamber 620 may
be proportional to reference volume 1508. The ratio of these two volumes
(in the ideal model) may only depend on the geometry of the resonant port
(e.g., port 1510; FIG. 103) and has no dependence upon temperature.
[0644] Exponential Volume Model
[0645] Assume the flow out through the flow resistance has the following
form:
V . out = V avs .tau. [ EQ #124 ] ##EQU00075##
[0646] Assuming a fixed input flow rate from the pump chamber, the volume
of volume sensor chamber 620 is based upon the following differential
equation:
V . avs = V . i n - V . out = V . i
n - V avs .tau. ] [ EQ #125 ] ##EQU00076##
[0647] which gives the following solution assuming a zero initial volume:
V avs = V . i n .tau. ( 1 - e - t .tau. )
[ EQ #126 ] ##EQU00077##
[0648] Accordingly, the output flow rate flows:
V . out = V . i n ( 1 - e - t .tau. )
[ EQ #127 ] ##EQU00078##
[0649] The volume delivered during the pump phase may be written:
V out = V . i n [ t - .tau. ( 1 - e - t .tau.
) ] [ EQ #128 ] ##EQU00079##
[0650] Device Calibration
[0651] The model fit allows the resonant frequency of the port to be
extracted from the sine sweep data. The next step is to relate this value
to the delivered volume. The ideal relationship between the resonant
frequency and the delivered volume to be expressed as follows:
.omega. n 2 = a 2 A L 1 V 2 [ EQ #129 ]
##EQU00080##
[0652] The speed of sound will vary with temperature, so it may be useful
to split out the temperature effects.
.omega. n 2 = .gamma. RA L T V 2 [ EQ
#130 ] ##EQU00081##
[0653] The volume may then be expressed as a function of the measured
resonant frequency and the temperature:
V 2 = C T .omega. n 2 [ EQ #131 ] ##EQU00082##
C = .gamma. RA L ##EQU00083##
[0654] Where c is the calibration constant
[0655] Implementation Details
[0656] End Effects
[0657] The air resonating in the port (e.g., port assembly 624) may extend
out into the acoustic volumes at the end of each oscillation. The
distance the air extends may be estimated based on the fundamental volume
sensor assembly equations. For any given acoustic volume, the distance
the air extends into the volume may be expressed as a function of the
pressure and port cross-sectional area:
x = V .rho. a 2 A p [ EQ #132 ]
##EQU00084##
[0658] If we assume the following values:
V = 28.8 .times. 10 - 6 L [ EQ #133 ] .rho. =
1.292 kg m 3 [ EQ #134 ] a = 340 m s [ EQ
#135 ] d = 0.5 mm [ EQ #136 ] p = 1 Pa
( Approximately 100 dB ) [ EQ #137 ]
##EQU00085##
[0659] Accordingly, the air will extend roughly 1.9 mm in to the acoustic
chamber.
[0660] Sizing V1 (i.e., the Fixed Volume) Relative to V2 (i.e., the
Variable Volume)
[0661] Sizing V.sub.1 (e.g., fixed volume 1500) may require trading off
acoustic volume with the relative position of the poles and zeros in the
transfer function. The transfer function for both V.sub.1 and V.sub.2
(e.g., variable volume 1502) are shown below relative to the volume
displacement of speaker assembly 622.
p 2 v k = - .rho. a 2 V 1 .omega. n 2
s 2 + 2 .zeta..omega. n s + .alpha..omega. n 2 [ EQ
#138 ] p 1 v k = - .rho. a 2 V 1 s 2
+ 2 .zeta..omega. n s + .alpha..omega. n 2 s 2 + 2
.zeta..omega. n s + .omega. n 2 [ EQ #139 ] where
.omega. n 2 = a 2 A L 1 V 2 , .zeta. = fA
2 L .omega. n and .alpha. = ( 1 + V 2
V 1 ) [ EQ #140 ] ##EQU00086##
[0662] As V.sub.1 is increased the gain may decrease and the speaker may
be driven at a higher amplitude to get the same sound pressure level.
However, increasing V.sub.1 may also have the benefit of moving the
complex zeros in the p.sub.1 transfer function toward the complex poles.
In the limiting case where V.sub.1.fwdarw..infin., .alpha..fwdarw.1 and
you have pole-zero cancellation and a flat response. Increasing V.sub.1,
therefore, may have the benefit of reducing both the resonance and the
notch in the p.sub.1 transfer function, and moving the p.sub.2 poles
toward .omega..sub.n; resulting in a lower sensitivity to measurement
error when calculating the p.sub.2/p.sub.1 transfer function.
[0663] FIG. 104 is a graphical representation of:
p 1 v k [ EQ #141 ] ##EQU00087##
[0664] FIG. 105 is a graphical representation of
p 2 v k [ EQ #142 ] ##EQU00088##
[0665] Aliasing
[0666] Higher frequencies may alias down to the frequency of interest,
wherein the aliased frequency may be expressed as follows:
f=|f.sub.n-nf.sub.s| [EQ#143]
[0667] where f.sub.s is the sampling frequency, f.sub.n is the frequency
of the noise source, n is a positive integer, and f is the aliased
frequency of the noise source.
[0668] The demodulation routine may effectively filter out noise except at
the specific frequency of the demodulation. If the sample frequency is
set dynamically to be a fixed multiple of the demodulation frequency,
then the frequency of the noise that can alias down to the demodulation
frequency may be a fixed set of harmonics of that fundamental frequency.
[0669] For example, if the sampling frequency is eight times the
demodulation frequency, then the noise frequencies that can alias down to
that frequency are as follows:
[ EQ #144 ] ##EQU00089## f n f = { 1 n
.beta. + 1 , 1 n .beta. - 1 } = { 1 7 , 1 9 ,
1 15 , 1 17 , 1 23 , 1 25 , } where .beta. =
f s f = 8. ##EQU00089.2##
For .beta.=16, the following series would result:
f n f = { 1 15 , 1 17 , 1 31 , 1 33 , } [ EQ
#145 ] ##EQU00090##
[0670] Performance
[0671] Sensitivity to Temperature
[0672] The sensitivity to temperature may be split into a gain change and
a noise change. If the temperature is off by a factor of dT, the
resulting gain error may be:
V 2 = c ( T 2 .omega. 2 2 - T 1 .omega. 1 2 )
[ EQ #147 ] ##EQU00091##
[0673] Accordingly, if the same temperature is used for both sine sweeps,
any error in the temperature measurement may look like a gain change to
the system.
e gain = 1 - T measured T actual [ EQ #148 ]
##EQU00092##
[0674] Therefore, for a 1.degree. K temperature error, the resulting
volume error may be 0.3% at 298.degree. K. This error may include both
the error in the temperature sensor and the difference between the sensor
temperature and the temperature of the air within volume sensor assembly
148.
[0675] The measurement, however, may be more susceptible to noise in the
temperature measurement. A temperature change during the differential
sine sweeps may result in an error that looks more like an offset rather
than a gain change:
V error = c .omega. 2 .DELTA. T [ EQ #149 ]
##EQU00093##
[0676] Accordingly, if the measurement varies by 0.1 K during the two
measurement sine sweeps, the difference may be 0.012 uL. Therefore, it
may be better to use a consistent temperature estimate for each delivery
rather than taking a separate temperature measurement for each sine sweep
(as shown in FIG. 107).
[0677] The LM73 temperature sensor has a published accuracy of
+/-1.degree. C. and a resolution of 0.03 C. Further, the LM73 temperature
sensor seems to consistently have a startup transient of about
0.3.degree. C. that takes about five sine sweeps to level out (as shown
in FIG. 108).
Since the above-described infusion pump assemblies (e.g., infusion pump
assembly 100, 100', 400, 500) provides discrete deliveries of infusible
fluid, the above-described infusion pump assemblies may be modeled
entirely in the discrete domain (in the manner shown in FIG. 109), which
may be reduced to the following:
G p ( z ) = Kz z - 1 [ EQ #150 ] ##EQU00094##
[0678] A discrete-time PI regulator may perform according to the
following:
G c ( z ) = K p ( 1 + T s T I z z - 1 )
[ EQ #151 ] ##EQU00095##
[0679] The AVS system described above works by comparing the acoustic
response in fixed volume 1500 and variable volume 1502 to a speaker
driven input and extracting the volume of the variable volume 1502. As
such, there is a microphone in contact with each of these separate
volumes (e.g., microphones 626, 630). The response of variable volume
microphone 630 may also be used in a more gross manner to detect the
presence or absence of disposable housing assembly 114. Specifically, if
disposable housing assembly 114 is not attached to (i.e., positioned
proximate) variable volume 1502, essentially no acoustic response to the
speaker driven input should be sensed. The response of fixed volume 1500,
however, should remain tied to the speaker input. Thus, the microphone
data may be used to determine whether disposable housing assembly 114 by
simply ensuring that both microphones exhibit an acoustic response. In
the event that microphone 626 (i.e., the microphone positioned proximate
fixed volume 1500) exhibits an acoustic response and microphone 630
(i.e., the microphone positioned proximate variable volume 1502) does not
exhibit an acoustic response, it may be reasonably concluded that
disposable housing assembly 114 is not attached to reusable housing
assembly 102. It should be noted that a failure of variable volume
microphone 630 may also appear to be indicative of disposable housing
assembly 114 not being attached, as the failure of variable volume
microphone 630 may result in a mid-range reading that is nearly
indistinguishable from the microphone response expected when disposable
housing assembly 114 is not attached.
[0680] For the following discussion, the following nomenclature may be
used:
TABLE-US-00010
Symbols
.alpha..sub.max(f) maximum read at a given frequency
.alpha..sub.min(f) minimum read at a given frequency
.delta. difference between max and min sums
f individual frequency
F set of sine sweep frequencies
N number of frequencies in each sine sweep, F
.PHI. boolean disposable attached flag
.sigma.max sum of maximum ADC reads
.sigma.min sum of minimum ADC reads
T max/min ADC difference threshold
Subscripts
i sweep number
ref reference volume
var variable volume
[0681] As part of the demodulation routine employed in each frequency
response calculation, the minimum and maximum readings of both fixed
volume microphone 626 and variable volume microphone 630 may be
calculated. The sum of these maximum and minimum values may be calculated
over the entire sine-sweep (as discussed above) for both microphone 626
and microphone 630 as follows.
.sigma.max = f .di-elect cons. F .alpha. max ( f )
[ EQ #152 ] .sigma.min = f .di-elect cons. F
.alpha. min ( f ) [ EQ #153 ] ##EQU00096##
[0682] and the difference between these two summations may be simplified
as follows:
.delta.=.sigma.max-.sigma.min [EQ#154]
[0683] While .delta. may be divided by the number of sine sweeps to get
the average minimum/maximum difference for the sine sweep (which is then
compared to a threshold), the threshold may equivalently be multiplied by
N for computational efficiency. Accordingly, the basic disposable
detection algorithm may be defined as follows:
.phi. i = { 1 if .delta. var > N * T 0
if .delta. var < N * T & .delta. ref
> N * T [ EQ #155 ] ##EQU00097##
[0684] The additional condition that the maximum/minimum difference be
greater than the threshold is a check performed to ensure that a failed
speaker is not the cause of the acoustic response received. This
algorithm may be repeated for any sine-sweep, thus allowing a detachment
of disposable housing assembly 114 to be sensed within e.g., at most two
consecutive sweeps (i.e., in the worst case scenario in which disposable
housing assembly 114 is removed during the second half of an in-progress
sine sweep).
[0685] Thresholding for the above-described algorithm may be based
entirely on numerical evidence. For example, examination of typical
minimum/maximum response differences may show that no individual
difference is ever less than five hundred ADC counts. Accordingly, all
data examined while disposable housing assembly 114 is detached from
reusable housing assembly 102 may show that all minimum/maximum response
differences as being well under five hundred ADC counts. Thus, the
threshold for .delta. may be set at T=500.
[0686] While volume sensor assembly 148 is described above as being
utilized within an infusion pump assembly (e.g., infusion pump assembly
100), this is for illustrative purposes only and is not intended to be a
limitation of this disclosure, as other configurations are possible and
are considered to be within the scope of this disclosure. For example,
volume sensor assembly 148 may be used within a process control
environment for e.g., controlling the quantity of chemicals mixed
together. Alternatively, volume sensor assembly 148 may be used within a
beverage dispensing system to control e.g., the quantity of ingredients
mixed together.
[0687] While volume sensor assembly 148 is described above as utilizing a
port (e.g., port assembly 624) as a resonator, this is for illustrative
purposes only, as other configurations are possible and are considered to
be within the scope of this disclosure. For example, a solid mass (not
shown) may be suspended within port assembly 624 and may function as a
resonator for volume sensor assembly 148. Specifically, the mass (not
shown) for the resonator may be suspended on a diaphragm (not shown)
spanning port assembly 624. Alternatively, the diaphragm itself (not
shown) may act as the mass for the resonator. The natural frequency of
volume sensor assembly 148 may be a function of the volume of variable
volume 1502. Accordingly, if the natural frequency of volume sensor
assembly 148 can be measured, the volume of variable volume 1502 may be
calculated.
[0688] The natural frequency of volume sensor assembly 148 may be measured
in a number of different ways. For example, a time-varying force may be
applied to the diaphragm (not shown) and the relationship between that
force and the motion of the diaphragm (not shown) may be used to estimate
the natural frequency of volume sensor assembly 148. Alternately the mass
(not shown) may be perturbed and then allowed to oscillate. The unforced
motion of the mass (not shown) may then be used to calculate the natural
frequency of volume sensor assembly 148.
[0689] The force applied to the resonant mass (not shown) may be
accomplished in various ways, examples of which may include but are not
limited to: [0690] speaker assembly 622 may create a time-varying
pressure within fixed volume 1500; [0691] the resonant mass (not shown)
may be a piezoelectric material responding to a time-varying
voltage/current; and [0692] the resonant mass (not shown) may be a voice
coil responding to a time-varying voltage/current
[0693] The force applied to the resonant mass may be measured in various
ways, examples of which may include but are not limited to: [0694]
measuring the pressure in the fixed volume; [0695] the resonant mass (not
shown) may be a piezoelectric material; and [0696] a strain gauge may be
connected to the diaphragm (not shown) or other structural member
supporting the resonant mass (not shown).
[0697] Similarly, the displacement of the resonant mass (not shown) may be
estimated by measuring the pressure in the variable volume, or measured
directly in various ways, examples of which may include but are not
limited to: [0698] via piezoelectric sensor; [0699] via capacitive
sensor; [0700] via optical sensor; [0701] via Hall-effect sensor; [0702]
via a potentiometer (time varying impedance) sensor; [0703] via an
inductive type sensor; and [0704] via a linear variable differential
transformer (LVDT)
[0705] Further, the resonant mass (not shown) may be integral to either
the force or displacement type sensor (i.e. the resonant mass (not shown)
may be made of piezoelectric material).
[0706] The application of force and measurement of displacement may be
accomplished by a single device. For example, a piezoelectric material
may be used for the resonant mass (not shown) and a time-varying
voltage/current may be applied to the piezoelectric material to create a
time-varying force. The resulting voltage/current applied to the
piezoelectric material may be measured and the transfer function between
the two used to estimate the natural frequency of volume sensor assembly
148.
[0707] As discussed above, the resonant frequency of volume sensor
assembly 148 may be estimated using swept-sine system identification.
Specifically, the above-described model fit may allow the resonant
frequency of the port assembly to be extracted from the sine sweep data,
which may then be used to determine the delivered volume. The ideal
relationship between the resonant frequency and the delivered volume may
be expressed as follows:
.omega. n 2 = a 2 A L 1 V 2 [ EQ #126 ]
##EQU00098##
[0708] The speed of sound will vary with temperature, so it may be useful
to split out the temperature effects.
.omega. n 2 = .gamma. RA L T V 2 [ EQ
#126 ] ##EQU00099##
[0709] The volume may then be expressed as a function of the measured
resonant frequency and the temperature:
V 2 = C T .omega. n 2 [ EQ #127 ] ##EQU00100##
[0710] Where c is the calibration constant
C = .gamma. RA L . ##EQU00101##
[0711] Infusion pump assembly 100 may then compare this calculated volume
V.sub.2 (i.e., representative of the actual volume of infusible fluid
delivered to the user) to the target volume (i.e., representative of the
quantity of fluid that was supposed to be delivered to the user). For
example, assume that infusion pump assembly 100 was to deliver a 0.100
unit basal dose of infusible fluid to the user every thirty minutes.
Further, assume that upon effectuating such a delivery, volume sensor
assembly 148 indicates a calculated volume V.sub.2 (i.e., representative
of the actual volume of infusible fluid delivered to the user) of 0.095
units of infusible fluid.
[0712] When calculating volume V.sub.2, infusion pump assembly 100 may
first determine the volume of fluid within volume sensor chamber 620
prior to the administration of the dose of infusible fluid and may
subsequently determine the volume of fluid within volume sensor chamber
620 after the administration of the dose of infusible fluid, wherein the
difference of those two measurements is indicative of V.sub.2 (i.e., the
actual volume of infusible fluid delivered to the user). Accordingly,
V.sub.2 is a differential measurement.
[0713] V2 may be the total air space over the diaphragm in the variable
volume chamber. The actual fluid delivery to the patient may be the
difference in V2 from when the chamber was full to after the measurement
valve was opened and the chamber was emptied. V2 may not directly be the
delivered volume. For example, the air volume may be measured and a
series of differential measurements may be taken. For occlusion, an empty
measurement may be taken, the chamber may be filed, a full measurement
may be taken, and then a final measurement may be taken after the exit
valve is open. Accordingly, the difference between the first and second
measurement may be the amount pumped and the difference between the
second and third is the amount delivered to the patient.
[0714] Accordingly, electrical control assembly 110 may determine that the
infusible fluid delivered is 0.005 units under what was called for. In
response to this determination, electrical control assembly 110 may
provide the appropriate signal to mechanical control assembly 104 so that
any additional necessary dosage may be pumped. Alternatively, electrical
control assembly 110 may provide the appropriate signal to mechanical
control assembly 104 so that the additional dosage may be dispensed with
the next dosage. Accordingly, during administration of the next 0.100
unit dose of the infusible fluid, the output command for the pump may be
modified based on the difference between the target and amount delivered.
[0715] Referring also to FIG. 110, there is shown one particular
implementation of a control system for controlling the quantity of
infusible fluid currently being infused based, at least in part, on the
quantity of infusible fluid previously administered. Specifically and
continuing with the above-stated example, assume for illustrative
purposes that electrical control assembly 110 calls for the delivery of a
0.100 unit dose of the infusible fluid to the user. Accordingly,
electrical control assembly 110 may provide a target differential volume
signal 1600 (which identifies a partial basal dose of 0.010 units of
infusible fluid per cycle of shape memory actuator 112) to volume
controller 1602. Accordingly and in this particular example, shape memory
actuator 112 may need to be cycled ten times in order to achieve the
desired basal dose of 0.100 units of infusible fluid (i.e., 10
cycles.times.0.010 units per cycle=0.100 units). Volume controller 1602
in turn may provide "on-time" signal 1606 to SMA (i.e., shape memory
actuator) controller 1608. Also provided to SMA controller 1608 is
battery voltage signal 1610.
[0716] Specifically, shape-memory actuator 112 may be controlled by
varying the amount of thermal energy (e.g., joules) applied to
shape-memory actuator 112. Accordingly, if the voltage level of battery
606 is reduced, the quantity of joules applied to shape-memory actuator
112 may also be reduced for a defined period of time. Conversely, if the
voltage level of battery 606 is increased, the quantity of joules applied
to shape memory actuator 112 may also be increased for a defined period
of time. Therefore, by monitoring the voltage level of battery 606 (via
battery voltage signal 1610), the type of signal applied to shape-memory
actuator 112 may be varied to ensure that the appropriate quantity of
thermal energy is applied to shape-memory actuator 112 regardless of the
battery voltage level.
[0717] SMA controller 1608 may process "on-time" signal 1606 and battery
voltage signal 1610 to determine the appropriate SMA drive signal 1612 to
apply to shape-memory actuator 112. One example of SMA drive signal 1612
may be a series of binary pulses in which the amplitude of SMA drive
signal 1612 essentially controls the stroke length of shape-memory
actuator 112 (and therefore pump assembly 106) and the duty cycle of SMA
drive signal 1612 essentially controls the stroke rate of shape-memory
actuator 112 (and therefore pump assembly 106). Further, since SMA drive
signal 1612 is indicative of a differential volume (i.e., the volume
infused during each cycle of shape memory actuator 112), SMA drive signal
1612 may be integrated by discrete time integrator 1614 to generate
volume signal 1616 which may be indicative of the total quantity of
infusible fluid infused during a plurality of cycles of shape memory
actuator 112. For example, since (as discussed above) it may take ten
cycles of shape memory actuator 112 (at 0.010 units per cycle) to infuse
0.100 units of infusible fluid, discrete time integrator 1614 may
integrate SMA drive signal 1612 over these ten cycles to determine the
total quantity infused of infusible fluid (as represented by volume
signal 1616).
[0718] SMA drive signal 1612 may actuate pump assembly 106 for e.g. one
cycle, resulting in the filling of volume sensor chamber 620 included
within volume sensor assembly 148. Infusion pump assembly 100 may then
make a first measurement of the quantity of fluid included within volume
sensor chamber 620 (as discussed above). Further and as discussed above,
measurement valve assembly 610 may be subsequently energized, resulting
in all or a portion of the fluid within volume sensor chamber 620 being
delivered to the user. Infusion pump assembly 100 may then make a
measurement of the quantity of fluid included within volume sensor
chamber 620 (as described above) and use those two measurements to
determine V.sub.2 (i.e., the actual volume of infusible fluid delivered
to the user during the current cycle of shape memory actuator 112). Once
determined, V.sub.2 (i.e., as represented by signal 1618) may be provided
(i.e., fed back) to volume controller 1602 for comparison to the
earlier-received target differential volume.
[0719] Continuing with the above-stated example in which the differential
target volume was 0.010 units of infusible fluid, assume that V.sub.2
(i.e., as represented by signal 1618) identifies 0.009 units of infusible
fluid as having been delivered to the user. Accordingly, infusion pump
assembly 100 may increase the next differential target volume to 0.011
units to offset the earlier 0.001 unit shortage. Accordingly and as
discussed above, the amplitude and/or duty cycle of SMA drive signal 1612
may be increased when delivering the next basal dose of the infusible
fluid to the user. This process may be repeated for the remaining nine
cycles of shape memory actuator 112 (as discussed above) and discrete
time integrator 1614 may continue to integrate SMA drive signal 1612 (to
generate volume signal 1616) which may define the total quantity of
infusible fluid delivered to the user.
[0720] Referring also to FIG. 111, there is shown one possible embodiment
of volume controller 1602. In this particular implementation, volume
controller 1602 may include PI (proportional-integrator) controller 1650.
Volume controller 1602 may include feed forward controller 1652 for
setting an initial "guess" concerning "on-time" signal 1606. For example,
for the situation described above in which target differential volume
signal 1600 identifies a partial basal dose of 0.010 units of infusible
fluid per cycle of shape memory actuator 112, feed forward controller
1652 may define an initial "on-time" of e.g., one millisecond. Feed
forward controller 1652 may include e.g., a lookup table that define an
initial "on-time" that is based, at least in part, upon target
differential volume signal 1600. Volume controller 1602 may further
include discrete time integrator 1654 for integrating target differential
volume signal 1600 and discrete time integrator 1656 for integrating
V.sub.2 (i.e., as represented by signal 1618).
[0721] Referring also to FIG. 112, there is shown one possible embodiment
of feed forward controller 1652. In this particular implementation, feed
forward controller 1652 may define a constant value signal 1658 and may
include amplifier 1660 (e.g., a unity gain amplifier), the output of
which may be summed with constant value signal 1658 at summing node 1662.
The resulting summed signal (i.e., signal 1664) may be provided to as an
input signal to e.g., lookup table 1666, which may be processed to
generate the output signal of feed forward controller 1652.
[0722] As discussed above, pump assembly 106 may be controlled by shape
memory actuator 112. Further and as discussed above, SMA controller 1608
may process "on-time" signal 1606 and battery voltage signal 1610 to
determine the appropriate SMA drive signal 1612 to apply to shape-memory
actuator 112.
[0723] Referring also to FIGS. 113-114, there is shown one particular
implementation of SMA controller 1608. As discussed above, SMA controller
1608 may be responsive to "on-time" signal 1606 and battery voltage
signal 1610 and may provide SMA drive signal 1612 to shape-memory
actuator 112. SMA controller 1608 may include a feedback loop (including
unit delay 1700), the output of which may be multiplied with battery
voltage signal 1610 at multiplier 1702. The output of multiplier 1702 may
be amplified with e.g., unity gain amplifier 1704. The output of
amplifier 1704 may be applied to the negative input of summing node 1706
(to which "on-time" signal 1606 is applied). The output of summing node
1706 may be amplified (via e.g., unity gain amplifier 1708). SMA
controller may also include feed forward controller 1710 to provide an
initial value for SMA drive signal 1612 (in a fashion similar to feed
forward controller 1652 of volume controller 1602; See FIG. 112). The
output of feed forward controller 1710 may be summed at summing node 1712
with the output of amplifier 1708 and an integrated representation (i.e.,
signal 1714) of the output of amplifier 1708 to form SMA drive signal
1612.
[0724] SMA drive signal 1612 may be provided to control circuitry that
effectuates the application of power to shape-memory actuator 112. For
example, SMA drive signal 1612 may be applied to switching assembly 1716
that may selectively apply current signal 1718 (supplied from battery
606) and/or fixed signal 1720 to shape-memory actuator. For example, SMA
drive signal 1612 may effectuate the application of energy (supplied from
battery 606 via current signal 1718) via switching assembly 1716 in a
manner that achieves the duty cycle defined by SMA drive signal 1612.
Unit delay 1722 may generate a delayed version of the signal applied to
shape-memory actuator 112 to form battery voltage signal 1610 (which may
be applied to SMA controller 1608).
[0725] When applying power to shape-memory actuator 112, voltage may be
applied for a fixed amount of time and: a) at a fixed duty cycle with an
unregulated voltage; b) at a fixed duty cycle with a regulated voltage;
c) at a variable duty cycle based upon a measured current value; d) at a
variable duty cycle based upon a measured voltage value; and e) at a
variable duty cycle based upon the square of a measured voltage value.
Alternatively, voltage may be applied to shape-memory actuator 112 for a
variable amount of time based upon a measured impedance.
[0726] When applying an unregulated voltage for a fixed amount of time at
a fixed duty cycle, inner loop feedback may not be used and shape memory
actuator may be driven at a fixed duty cycle and with an on-time
determined by the outer volume loop.
[0727] When applying a regulated voltage for a fixed amount of time at a
fixed duty cycle, inner loop feedback may not be used and shape memory
actuator 112 may be driven at a fixed duty cycle and with an on-time
determined by the outer volume loop.
[0728] When applying an unregulated voltage at a variable duty cycle based
upon a measured current value, the actual current applied to shape-memory
actuator 112 may be measured and the duty cycle may be adjusted during
the actuation of shape-memory actuator 112 to maintain the correct mean
current.
[0729] When applying an unregulated voltage at a variable duty cycle based
upon a measured voltage value, the actual voltage applied to shape-memory
actuator 112 may be measured and the duty cycle may be adjusted during
the actuation of shape-memory actuator 112 to maintain the correct mean
voltage.
[0730] When applying an unregulated voltage at a variable duty cycle based
upon the square of a measured voltage value, the actual voltage applied
to shape-memory actuator 112 may be measured and the duty cycle may be
adjusted during the actuation of shape-memory actuator 112 to maintain
the square of the voltage at a level required to provide the desired
level of power to shape-memory actuator 112 (based upon the impedance of
shape-memory actuator 112).
[0731] Referring also to FIG. 114A-114B, there is shown other
implementations of SMA controller 1608. Specifically, FIG. 114A is an
electrical schematic that includes a microprocessor and various control
loops that may be configured to provide a PWM signal that may open and
close the switch assembly. The switch assembly may control the current
that is allowed to flow through the shape memory actuator. The battery
may provide the current to the shape memory actuator. Further, 114B
discloses a volume controller and an inner shape memory actuator
controller. The shape memory actuator controller may provide a PWM signal
to the pump, which may be modified based on the battery voltage. This may
occur for a fixed ontime, the result being a volume that may be measured
by volume sensor assembly 148 and fed back into the volume controller.
[0732] In our preferred embodiment, we vary the duty cycle based on the
measured battery voltage to give you approximately consistent power. We
adjust the duty cycle to compensate for a lower battery voltage. Battery
voltage may change for two reasons: 1) as batteries are discharged, the
voltage slowly decreases; and 2) when you apply a load to a battery it
has an internal impedance so its voltage dips. This is something that
happens in any type of system, and we compensate for that by adjusting
the duty cycle, thus mitigating the lower or varying battery voltage.
Battery voltage may be measured by the microprocessor. In other systems:
1) voltage may be regulated (put a regulator to maintain the voltage at a
steady voltage); 2) feedback based on something else (i.e., speed or
position of a motor, not necessarily measuring the battery voltage).
[0733] Other configurations may be utilized to control the shape memory
actuator. For example: A) the shape memory actuator may be controlled at
fixed duty cycle with unregulated voltage. As voltage varies, the
repeatablity of heating the shape memory actuator is reduced. B) a fixed
duty cycle, regulated voltage may be utilized which compensate for
changes in battery voltage. However, regulate the voltage down is less
efficient due to energy of energy. C) the duty cycle may be varied based
on changes in current (which may required more complicated measurement
circuitry. D) The duty cycle may be varied based on measured voltage. E)
The duty cycle may be varied based upon the square of the current. or the
square of the voltage divided by resistance. F) the voltage may be
applied for a variable amount of time based on the measured impedance
(e.g., may measure impedance using Wheatstone gauge (not shown)). The
impedance of the shape memory actuator may be correlated to strain (i.e.,
may correlate how much the SMA moves based on its impedance).
[0734] Referring also to FIG. 115 and as discussed above, to enhance the
safety of infusion pump assembly 100, electrical control assembly 110 may
include two separate and distinct microprocessors, namely supervisor
processor 1800 and command processor 1802. Specifically, command
processor 1802 may perform the functions discussed above (e.g.,
generating SMA drive signal 1612) and may control relay/switch assemblies
1804, 1806 that control the functionality of (in this example) shape
memory actuators 112, 632 (respectively). Command processor 1802 may
receive feedback from signal conditioner 1808 concerning the condition
(e.g., voltage level) of the voltage signal applied to shape memory
actuators 112, 632. Command processor 1800 may control relay/switch
assembly 1810 independently of relay/switch assemblies 1804, 1806.
Accordingly, when an infusion event is desired, both of supervisor
processor 1800 and command processor 1802 must agree that the infusion
event is proper and must both actuate their respective relays/switches.
In the event that either of supervisor processor 1800 and command
processor 1802 fails to actuate their respective relays/switches, the
infusion event will not occur. Accordingly through the use of supervisor
processor 1800 and command processor 1802 and the cooperation and
concurrence that must occur, the safety of infusion pump assembly 100 is
enhanced.
[0735] The supervisor processor may prevent the command processor from
delivering when it is not supposed and also may alarm if the command
processor does not deliver when it should be delivering. The supervisor
processor may deactivate the relay/switch assembly if the command
processor actuates the wrong switch, or if the command processor it tries
to apply power for too long.
[0736] The supervisor processor may redundantly doing calculations for how
much insulin should be delivered (i.e., double checking the calculations
of the command processor). Command processor may decide the delivery
schedule, and the supervisor processor may redundantly check those
calculations.
[0737] Supervisor also redundantly holds the profiles (delivery profiles)
in RAM, so the command processor may be doing the correct calculations,
but if is has bad RAM, would cause the command to come up with the wrong
result. The Supervisor uses its local copy of the basal profile, etc., to
double check.
[0738] Supervisor can double check AVS measurements, looks at the AVS
calculations and applies safety checks. Every time AVS measurement is
taken, it double checks.
[0739] Referring also to FIG. 116, one or more of supervisor processor
1800 and command processor 1802 may perform diagnostics on various
portions of infusion pump assembly 100. For example, voltage dividers
1812, 1814 may be configured to monitor the voltages (V1 & V2
respectively) sensed at distal ends of e.g., shape memory actuator 112.
The value of voltages V1 & V2 in combination with the knowledge of the
signals applied to relay/switch assemblies 1804, 1810 may allow for
diagnostics to be performed on various components of the circuit shown in
FIG. 116 (in a manner similar to that shown in illustrative diagnostic
table 1816).
[0740] As discussed above and as illustrated in FIGS. 115-116, to enhance
the safety of infusion pump assembly 100, electrical control assembly 110
may include a plurality of microprocessors (e.g., supervisor processor
1800 and command processor 1802), each of which may be required to
interact and concur in order to effectuate the delivery of a dose of the
infusible fluid. In the event that the microprocessors fail to
interact/concur, the delivery of the dose of infusible fluid may fail and
one or more alarms may be triggered, thus enhancing the safety and
reliability of infusion pump assembly 100.
[0741] A master alarm may be utilized that tracks the volume error over
time. Accordingly, if the sum of the errors becomes too large, the master
alarm may be initiated, indicating that something may be wrong with the
system. Accordingly, the master alarm may be indicative of a total volume
comparison being performed and a discrepancy being noticed. A typical
value of the discrepancy required to initiate the master alarm may be
1.00 milliliters. The master alarm may monitor the sum in a leaky fashion
(i.e., Inaccuracies have a time horizon).
[0742] Referring also to FIGS. 117A-117B, there is shown one such
illustrative example of such interaction amongst multiple microprocessors
during the delivery of a dose of the infusible fluid. Specifically,
command processor 1802 may first determine 1900 the initial volume of
infusible fluid within volume sensor chamber 620. Command processor 1802
may then provide 1902 a "pump power request" message to supervisor
processor 1800. Upon receiving 1904 the "pump power request" message,
supervisor processor 1800 may e.g., energize 1906 relay/switch 1810 (thus
energizing shape memory actuator 112) and may send 1908 a "pump power on"
message to command processor 1802. Upon receiving 1910 the "pump power
on" message, command processor 1802 may actuate 1912 e.g., pump assembly
106 (by energizing relay/switch 1804), during which time supervisor
processor 1800 may monitor 1914 the actuation of e.g., pump assembly 106.
[0743] Once actuation of pump assembly 106 is complete, command processor
1802 may provide 1914 a "pump power off" message to supervisor processor
1800. Upon receiving 1916 the "pump power off" message, supervisor
processor 1800 may deenergize 1918 relay/switch 1810 and provide 1920 a
"pump power off" message to command processor 1802. Upon receiving 1922
the "pump power off" message, command processor 1802 may measure 1924 the
quantity of infusible fluid pumped by pump assembly 106. This may be
accomplished by measuring the current quantity of fluid within volume
sensor chamber 620 and comparing it with the quantity determined above
(in step 1900). Once determined 1924, command processor 1802 may provide
1926 a "valve open power request" message to supervisor processor 1800.
Upon receiving 1928 the "valve open power request" message, supervisor
processor 1800 may energize 1930 relay/switch 1810 (thus energizing shape
memory actuator 632) and may send 1932 a "valve open power on" message to
command processor 1802. Upon receiving 1934 the "valve open power on"
message, command processor 1802 may actuate 1936 e.g., measurement valve
assembly 610 (by energizing relay/switch 1806), during which time
supervisor processor 1800 may monitor 1938 the actuation of e.g.,
measurement valve assembly 610.
[0744] Once actuation of measurement valve assembly 610 is complete,
command processor 1802 may provide 1940 a "valve power off" message to
supervisor processor 1800. Upon receiving 1942 the "valve power off"
message, supervisor processor 1800 may deenergize 1944 relay/switch 1810
and provide 1946 a "valve power off" message to command processor 1802.
Upon receiving 1948 the "valve power off" message, command processor 1802
may provide 1950 a "valve close power request" message to supervisor
processor 1800. Upon receiving 1952 the "valve close power request"
message, supervisor processor 1800 may energize 1954 relay/switch 1810
(thus energizing shape memory actuator 652) and may send 1956 a "power
on" message to command processor 1802. Upon receiving 1958 the "power on"
message, command processor 1802 may actuate 1960 an energizing
relay/switch (not shown) that is configured to energize shape memory
actuator 652, during which time supervisor processor 1800 may monitor
1962 the actuation of e.g., shape memory actuator 652.
[0745] As discussed above (and referring temporarily to FIGS. 26A, 26B,
27A, 27B & 28), shape memory actuator 652 may be anchored on a first end
using electrical contact 654. The other end of shape memory actuator 652
may be connected to bracket assembly 656. When shape memory actuator 652
is activated, shape memory actuator 652 may pull bracket assembly 656
forward and release valve assembly 634. As such, measurement valve
assembly 610 may be activated via shape memory actuator 632. Once
measurement valve assembly 610 has been activated, bracket assembly 656
may automatically latch valve assembly 610 in the activated position.
Actuating shape memory actuator 652 may pull bracket assembly 656 forward
and release valve assembly 634. Assuming shape memory actuator 632 is no
longer activated, measurement valve assembly 610 may move to a
de-activated state once bracket assembly 656 has released valve assembly
634. Accordingly, by actuating shape memory actuator 652, measurement
valve assembly 610 may be deactivated.
[0746] Once actuation of shape memory actuator 652 is complete, command
processor 1802 may provide 1964 a "power off" message to supervisor
processor 1800. Upon receiving 1966 the "power off" message, supervisor
processor 1800 may deenergize 1968 relay/switch 1810 and may provide 1970
a "power off" message to command processor 1802. Upon receiving 1972 the
"power off" message, command processor 1802 may determine the quantity of
infusible fluid within volume sensor chamber 620, thus allowing command
processor 1802 to compare this measured quantity to the quantity
determined above (in step 1924) to determine 1974 the quantity of
infusible fluid delivered to the user.
[0747] In the event that the quantity of infusible fluid delivered 1974 to
the user is less than the quantity of infusible fluid specified for the
basal/bolus infusion event, the above-described procedure may be repeated
(via loop 1976).
[0748] Referring also to FIG. 118, there is shown another illustrative
example of the interaction amongst processors 1800, 1802, this time
during the scheduling of a dose of infusible fluid. Command processor
1802 may monitor 2000, 2002 for the receipt of a basal scheduling message
or a bolus request message (respectively). Upon receipt 2000, 2002 of
either of these messages, command processor 1802 may set 2004 the desired
delivery volume and may provide 2006 a "delivery request" message to
supervisor processor 1800. Upon receiving 2008 the "delivery request"
message, supervisor processor 1800 may verify 2010 the volume defined
2004 by command processor 1802. Once verified 2010, supervisor processor
1800 may provide 2012 a "delivery accepted" message to command processor
1802. Upon receipt 2014 of the "delivery accepted" message, command
processor 1802 may update 2016 the controller (e.g., the controller
discussed above and illustrated in FIG. 110) and execute 2018 delivery of
the basal/bolus dose of infusible fluid. Command processor 1808 may
monitor and update 2022 the total quantity of infusible fluid delivered
to the user (as discussed above and illustrated in FIGS. 117A-117B). Once
the appropriate quantity of infusible fluid is delivered to the user,
command processor 1802 may provide 2024 a "delivery done" message to
supervisor processor 1800. Upon receipt 2026 of the "delivery done"
message, supervisor processor 1800 may update 2028 the total quantity of
infusible fluid delivered to the user. In the event that the total
quantity of infusible fluid delivered 2018 to the user is less than the
quantity defined above (in step 2004), the infusion process discussed
above may be repeated (via loop 2030).
[0749] Referring also to FIG. 119, there is shown an example of the manner
in which supervisor processor 1800 and command processor 1802 may
interact while effectuating a volume measurements via volume sensor
assembly 148 (as described above).
[0750] Specifically, command processor 1802 may initialize 2050 volume
sensor assembly 148 and begin collecting 2052 data from volume sensor
assembly 148, the process of which may be repeated for each frequency
utilized in the above-described sine sweep. Each time that data is
collected for a particular sweep frequency, a data point message may be
provided 2054 from command processor 1802, which may be received 2056 by
supervisor processor 1800.
[0751] Once data collection 2052 is completed for the entire sine sweep,
command processor 1802 may estimate 2058 the volume of infusible fluid
delivered by infusion pump assembly 100. Command processor 1802 may
provide 2060 a volume estimate message to supervisor processor 1800. Upon
receiving 2062 this volume estimate message, supervisor processor 1800
may check (i.e., confirm) 2064 the volume estimate message. Once checked
(i.e., confirmed), supervisor processor 1800 may provide 2066 a
verification message to command processor 1802. Once received 2068 from
supervisor processor 1800, command processor 1802 may set the measurement
status for the dose of infusible fluid delivered by volume sensor
assembly 148.
[0752] As discussed above and referring temporarily to FIG. 11), the
various embodiments of the infusion pump assembly (e.g., infusion pump
assembly 100, 100', 400, 500) discussed above may be configured via a
remote control assembly 300. When configurable via remote control
assembly 300, the infusion pump assembly may include telemetry circuitry
(not shown) that allows for communication (e.g., wired or wireless)
between the infusion pump assembly and e.g., remote control assembly 300,
thus allowing remote control assembly 300 to remotely control the
infusion pump assembly. Remote control assembly 300 (which may also
include telemetry circuitry (not shown) and may be capable of
communicating with the infusion pump assembly) may include display
assembly 302 and input assembly 304. Input assembly 304 may include
slider assembly 306 and switch assemblies 308, 310. In other embodiments,
the input assembly may include a jog wheel, a plurality of switch
assemblies, or the like. Remote control assembly 300 may allow the user
to program basal and bolus delivery events.
[0753] Remote control assembly 300 may include two processors, one
processor (e.g., which may include, but is not limited to a CC2510
microcontroller/RF transceiver, available from Chipcon AS, of Oslo,
Norway) may be dedicated to radio communication, e.g., for communicating
with infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500. The second processor
included within remote control assembly (which may include but are not
limited to an ARM920T and an ARM922T manufactured by ARM Holdings PLC of
the United Kingdom) may be a command processor and may perform data
processing tasks associated with e.g., configuring infusion pump assembly
100, 100', 400, 500.
[0754] Further and as discussed above, one embodiment of electrical
control assembly 816 may include three microprocessors. One processor
(e.g., which may include, but is not limited to a CC2510
microcontroller/RF transceiver, available from Chipcon AS, of Oslo,
Norway) may be dedicated to radio communication, e.g., for communicating
with a remote control assembly 300. Two additional microprocessors (e.g.,
supervisor processor 1800 and command processor 1802) may effectuate the
delivery of the infusible fluid (as discussed above). Examples of
supervisor processor 1800 and command processor 1802 may include, but is
not limited to an MSP430 microcontroller, available from Texas
Instruments Inc. of Dallas, Tex.
[0755] The OS may be a non-preemptive scheduling system, in that all tasks
may run to completion before the next task is allowed to run regardless
of priority. Additionally, context switches may not be performed. When a
task completes executing, the highest priority task that is currently
scheduled to run may then be executed. If no tasks are scheduled to
execute, the OS may place the processor (e.g., supervisor processor 1800
and/or command processor 1802) into a low power sleep mode and may wake
when the next task is scheduled. The OS may only be used to manage main
loop code and may leave interrupt-based functionality unaffected.
[0756] The OS may be written to take advantage of the C++ language.
Inheritance as well as virtual functions may be key elements of the
design, allowing for easy creation, scheduling and managing of tasks.
[0757] At the base of the OS infrastructure may be the ability to keep
track of system time and controlling the ability to place the processor
in Low Power Mode (LPM; also known as sleep mode). This functionality
along with the control and configuration of all system clocks, may be
encapsulated by the SysClocks class.
[0758] The SysClocks class may contain the functionality to place the
processor (e.g., supervisor processor 1800 and/or command processor 1802)
into LPM to reduce energy consumption. While in LPM, the slow real time
clock may continue to run while the fast system clock that runs the CPU
core and most peripherals may be disabled.
[0759] Placing the processor into LPM may always be done by the provided
SysClocks function. This function may contain all required power down and
power up sequences resulting in consistency whenever entering or exiting
LPM. Waking from LPM may be initiated by any interrupts based on the slow
clock.
[0760] The OS may keep track of three aspects of time: seconds,
milliseconds and the time of day. Concerning seconds, SysClocks may count
seconds starting when the processor comes out of reset. The second
counter may be based on the slow system clocks and, therefore, may
increment regardless of whether the processor is in LPM or at full power.
As a result, it is the boundary at which the processor may wake from
sleep to execute previously scheduled tasks. If a task is scheduled to
run immediately from an interrupt service routine (ISR), the ISR may wake
the processor from LPM on exit and the task may be executed immediately.
Concerning milliseconds, in addition to counting the seconds since power
on, SysClocks may also count milliseconds while the processor is in full
power mode. Since the fast clock is stopped during LPM, the millisecond
counter may not increment. Accordingly, whenever a task is scheduled to
execute based on milliseconds, the processor may not enter LPM.
Concerning time of day, the time of day may be represented within
SysClocks as seconds since a particular point time (e.g., seconds since 1
Jan. 2004).
[0761] The SysClocks class may provide useful functionality to be used
throughout the Command and Supervisor project code base. The code delays
may be necessary to allow hardware to settle or actions to be completed.
SysClocks may provide two forms of delays, a delay based on seconds or a
delay based on milliseconds. When a delay is used, the processor may
simply wait until the desired time has passed before continue with its
current code path. Only ISRs may be executed during this time. SysClocks
may provide all of the required functionality to set or retrieve the
current time of day.
[0762] The word "task" may be associated with more complex scheduling
systems; therefore within the OS, task may be represented by and referred
to as Managed Functions. The ManagedFunc class may be an abstract base
class that provides all the necessary control members and functionality
to manage and schedule the desired functionality.
[0763] The ManagedFunc base class may have five control members, two
scheduling manipulation member functions, and one pure virtual execute
function that may contain the managed functionality. All of the
ManagedFunc control members may be hidden from the derived class and may
only be directly set by the derived class during creation, thus
simplifying the use and enhancing the safety of infusion pump assembly
100, 100', 400, 500.
[0764] The Function ID may be set at the time of creation and may never be
changed. All Function IDs may be defined within a single .h file, and the
base ManagedFunc constructor may strongly enforce that the same ID may
not be used for more than one managed function. The ID may also define
the priority of a function (with respect to other functions) based upon
the function ID assigned, wherein higher priority functions are assigned
lower function IDs. The highest priority task that is currently scheduled
to execute may execute before lower priority tasks.
[0765] All other control members may be used to represent the function's
current scheduled state, when it should be executed, and if (upon
execution) the function should be rescheduled to execute in a previously
set amount of time. Manipulation of these controls and states may be
allowed but only through the public member functions (thus enforcing
safety controls on all settings).
[0766] To control the scheduling of a managed function, the set start and
set repeat functions may be used. Each of these member functions may be a
simple interface allowing the ability to configure or disable repeat
settings as well as control whether a managed function is inactive,
scheduled by seconds, milliseconds, or time of day.
[0767] Through inheritance, creating a Managed Function may be done by
creating a derived class and defining the pure virtual `execute` function
containing the code that needs to be under scheduling control. The
ManagedFunc base class constructor may be based upon the unique ID of a
function, but may also be used to set default control values to be used
at start up.
[0768] For example to create a function that runs thirty seconds after
start up and every 15 seconds thereafter, the desired code is placed into
the virtual execute function and the function ID, scheduled by second
state, thirty second start time, and repeat setting of fifteen seconds is
provided to the constructor.
[0769] The following is an illustrative code example concerning the
creation of a managed function. In this particular example, a "heartbeat"
function is created that is scheduled to execute for the first time one
second after startup of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 and
execute every ten seconds thereafter:
TABLE-US-00011
#include "ManagedFunc.h"
// The SendGoodFunc is a "heartbeat" status message
class SendGoodFunc : public ManagedFunc
{
public:
// Initialize the managed func to run 2 seconds after
start up
// and repeat every second.
SendGoodFunc( ) :
ManagedFunc(IPC_SEND_GOOD, SCHEDULED_SEC, 1,
true, 10) { };
~SendGoodFunc( ) { };
protected:
void execute(void);
};
void SendGoodFunc::execute(void)
{
// << code to send the heartbeat >>
}
SendGoodFunc g_sendGoodFunc;
// to manipulate the heartbeat timing simply call:
// g_sendGoodFunc.setFuncStart(...) or
g_sendGoodFunc.setRepeat( ... )
[0770] The actual execution of the Managed Functions may be controlled and
performed by the SleepManager class. The SleepManager may contain the
actual prioritized list of managed functions. This prioritized list of
functions may automatically be populated by the managed function creation
process and may ensure that each function is created properly and has a
unique ID.
[0771] The main role of the SleepManager class may be to have its `manage`
function called repeatedly from the processors main loop and/or from a
endless while loop. Upon each call of manage, the SleepManager may
execute all functions that are scheduled to run until the SleepManager
has exhausted all scheduled functions; at which time the SleepManager may
place the processor in LPM. Once the processor wakes from LPM, the manage
function may be reentered until the processor is again ready to enter LPM
(this process may be repeated until stopped, e.g., by a user or by the
system).
[0772] If the processor has to be kept in full power mode for an extended
period of time (e.g., while an analog-to-digital conversion is being
sampled), the SleepManager may provide functionality to disable entering
LPM. While LPM is disabled, the manage function may continuously search
for a scheduled task.
[0773] The SleepManager may also provide an interface to manipulate the
scheduling and repeat settings of any managed function through the use of
the unique ID of the function, which may allow any section of code to
perform any required scheduling without having direct access to or
unnecessary knowledge of the desired ManagedFunc object.
[0774] Radio circuitry included within each of infusion pump assembly 100,
100', 400, 500 and remote control assembly 300 may effectuate wireless
communication between remote control assembly 300 and infusion pump
assembly 100, 100', 400, 500. A 2.4 GHz radio communications chip (e.g.,
a Texas Instruments CC2510 radio transceiver) with an internal 8051
microcontroller may be used for radio communications.
[0775] The radio link may balance the following three objectives: link
availability; latency; and energy.
[0776] Concerning link availability, remote control assembly 300 may
provide the primary means for controlling the infusion pump assembly 100,
100', 400, 500 and may provide detailed feedback to the user via the
graphical user interface (GUI) of remote control assembly 300. Concerning
latency, the communications system may be designed to provide for low
latency to deliver data from remote control assembly 300 to the infusion
pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 (and vice versa). Concerning energy,
both remote control assembly 300 and infusion pump assembly 100, 100',
400, 500 may have a maximum energy expenditure for radio communications.
[0777] The radio link may support half-duplex communications. Remote
control assembly 300 may be the master of the radio link, initiating all
communications. Infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may only
respond to communications and may never initiate communications.
[0778] The use of such a radio communication system may provide various
benefits, such as: increased security: a simplified design (e.g., for
airplane use); and coordinated control of the radio link.
[0779] Referring also to FIG. 120A, there is shown one illustrative
example of the various software layers of the radio communication system
discussed above.
[0780] The radio processors included within remote control assembly 300
and infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may transfer messaging
packets between an SPI port and a 2.4 GHz radio link (and vice versa).
The radio may always be the SPI slave. On infusion pump assembly 100,
100', 400, 500, radio processor (PRP) 1818 (See FIGS. 115-116) may
service two additional nodes over the SPI port that are upstream (namely
command processor 1800 and supervisor processor 1802. In some
embodiments, on remote control assembly 300, the radio processor (CRP)
may service at least one additional node over the SPI port that may be
either upstream or down stream, for example, in some embodiments, the
above-described remote control processor (UI) and the Continuous Glucose
Engine (CGE).
[0781] A messaging system may allow for communication of messages between
various nodes in the network. The UI processor of remote control assembly
300 and e.g., supervisor processor 1800 may use the messaging system to
configure and initiate some of the mode switching on the two system
radios. It may be also used by the radios to convey radio and link status
information to other nodes in the network.
[0782] When the radio of remote control assembly 300 wishes to gather
channel statistics from the infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 or
update the master channel list of the radio of infusion pump assembly
100, 100', 400, 500, the radio of remote control assembly 300 may use
system messages. Synchronization for putting the new updated list into
effect may use flags in the heartbeat messages to remove timing
uncertainty.
[0783] The radio communication system may be written in C++ to be
compatible with the messaging software. A four byte radio serial number
may be used to address each radio node. A hash table may be used to
provide a one-to-one translation between the device "readable" serial
number string and the radio serial number. The hash table may provide a
more randomized 8-bit logical address so that pumps (e.g., infusion pump
assembly 100, 100', 400, 500) or controllers with similar readable serial
numbers are more likely to have unique logical addresses. Radio serial
numbers may not have to be unique between pumps (e.g., infusion pump
assembly 100, 100', 400, 500) and controllers due to the unique roles
each has in the radio protocol.
[0784] The radio serial number of remote control assembly 300 and the
radio serial number of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may be
included in all radio packets except for the RF Pairing Request message
that may only include the radio serial number of remote control assembly
300, thus ensuring that only occur with the remote control
assembly/infusion pump assembly to which it is paired. The CC2510 may
support a one byte logical node address and it may be advantageous to use
one byte of the radio serial number as the logical node address to
provide a level of filtering for incoming packets.
[0785] The Quiet_Radio signal may be used by the UI processor of remote
control assembly 300 to prevent noise interference on the board of remote
control assembly 300 by other systems on the board. When Quiet_Radio is
asserted, the radio application of remote control assembly 300 may send a
message to the radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500
asserting Radio Quiet Mode for a pre-determined period of time. The
Quiet_Radio feature may not be required based on noise interference
levels measured on the PC board of remote control assembly 300. During
this period of time, the radio of remote control assembly 300 may stay in
Sleep Mode 2 for up to a maximum of 100 ms. The radio of remote control
assembly 300 may come out of Sleep Mode 2 when the Quiet_Radio signal is
de-asserted or the maximum time period has expired. The UI processor of
remote control assembly 300 may assert Quiet_Radio at least one radio
communication's interval before the event needs to be asserted. The radio
of remote control assembly 300 may inform the radio of infusion pump
assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 that communications will be shutdown during
this quiet period. The periodic radio link protocol may have status
bits/bytes that accommodate the Quiet_Radio feature unless Quiet_Radio is
not required.
[0786] The radio software may integrate with the messaging system and
radio bootloader on the same processor, and may be verified using a
throughput test. The radio software may integrate with the messaging
system, SPI Driver using DMA, and radio bootloader, all on the same
processor (e.g., the TI CC2510).
[0787] The radio of remote control assembly 300 may be configured to
consume no more than 32 mAh in three days (assuming one hundred minutes
of fast heartbeat mode communications per day). The radio of infusion
pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may be configured to consume no more
than 25 mAh in three days (assuming one hundred minutes of fast heartbeat
mode communications per day).
[0788] The maximum time to reacquire communications may be <6.1 seconds
including connection request mode and acquisition mode. The radio of
remote control assembly 300 may use the fast heartbeat mode or slow
heartbeat mode setting to its advantage in order to conserve power and
minimize latency to the user. The difference between the infusion pump
assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 and remote control assembly 300 entering
acquisition mode may be that the infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400,
500 needs to enter acquisition mode often enough to ensure communications
may be restored within the maximum latency period. However, the remote
control assembly 300 may change how often to enter acquisition mode with
the infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 when in slow heartbeat
mode and heartbeats are lost. The radio of remote control assembly 300
may have knowledge of the user GUI interaction, but the infusion pump
assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may not.
[0789] The radio of remote control assembly 300 may set the heartbeat
period for both radios. The period may be selectable in order to optimize
power and link latency depending on activity. The desired heartbeat
period may be communicated in each heartbeat from the radio of remote
control assembly 300 to the radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100',
400, 500. This may not exclusively establish the heartbeat rate of
infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 due to other conditions that
determine what mode to be in. When in fast heartbeat mode, the radio of
remote control assembly 300 may set the heartbeat period to 20 ms if data
packets are available to send or receive, thus providing low link latency
communications when data is actively being exchanged.
[0790] When in fast heartbeat mode, the radio of remote control assembly
300 may set the heartbeat period to 60 ms four heartbeats after a data
packet was last exchanged in either direction on the radio. Keeping the
radio heartbeat period short after a data packet has been sent or
received may assure that any data response packet may be also serviced
using a low link latency. When in slow heartbeat mode, the heartbeat rate
may be 2.00 seconds or 6.00 second, depending upon online or offline
status respectively.
[0791] The infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may use the
heartbeat rate set by the radio of remote control assembly 300. The radio
of remote control assembly 300 may support the following mode requests
via the messaging system: [0792] Pairing Mode [0793] Connection Mode
[0794] Acquisition Mode (includes the desired paired infusion pump
assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 radio serial number) [0795] Sync Mode--Fast
Heartbeat [0796] Sync Mode--Slow Heartbeat [0797] RF Off Mode
[0798] The radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may support
the following mode requests via the messaging system: [0799] Pairing
Mode [0800] Acquisition Mode [0801] RF Off Mode
[0802] The radio may use a system message to obtain the local radio serial
number. On remote control assembly 300, the radio may get the serial
number from the UI processor of remote control assembly 300. The radio
may use a system message to store the paired radio serial number.
[0803] Remote control assembly 300 and the radio of infusion pump assembly
100, 100', 400, 500 may issue a status message using the messaging system
to the UI processor of remote control assembly 300 and command processor
1802 whenever the following status changes: [0804] Online Fast:
Successful connection [0805] Online Fast: Change from Acquisition Mode to
Fast Heartbeat Mode [0806] Online Slow: Successful request change from
Fast Heartbeat to Slow Heartbeat [0807] Offline: Automatic change to
Search Sync mode due to lack of heartbeat exchanges. [0808] Online Fast:
Successful request change from Slow Heartbeat to Fast Heartbeat [0809]
Offline: Bandwidth falls below 10% in Sync Mode [0810] Online: Bandwidth
rises above 10% in Search Sync mode [0811] Offline: Successful request
change to RF Off Mode
[0812] The radio configuration message may be used to configure the number
of radio retries. This message may be sent over the messaging system. The
UI processor of remote control assembly 300 will send this command to
both the radio of remote control assembly 300 and the radio of infusion
pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 to configure these radio settings.
[0813] There may be two parameters in the radio configuration message:
namely the number of RF retries (e.g., the value may be from 0 to 10);
and the radio offline parameters (e.g., the value may be from 1 to 100 in
percent of bandwidth).
[0814] The radio application on both the remote control assembly 300 and
infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may have an API that allows
the messaging system to configure the number of RF retries and radio
offline parameters.
[0815] The following parameters may be recommended for the radio hardware
configuration: [0816] Base Radio Specifications [0817] MSK [0818] 250
kbps over air baud rate [0819] Up to 84 channels [0820] Channel spacing
1000 kHz [0821] Filter bandwidth 812 kHz [0822] No Manchester encoding
[0823] Data whitening [0824] 4 byte preamble [0825] 4 byte sync (word)
[0826] CRC appended to packet [0827] LQI (Link Quality Indicator)
appended to packet [0828] Automatic CRC filtering enabled
[0829] Forward Error Correction (FEC) may or may not be utilized. Although
Forward Error Correction (FEC) may be used to increase the effective
signal dynamic range by approximately 3 dB, FEC requires fixed packet
sizes and doubles the number of over the air bits for the same fixed size
message.
[0830] The radio may function within 1.83 meters distance under nominal
operating conditions (except in pairing mode). It may be a goal that the
radio function within 7.32 meters distance under nominal operating
conditions. The transmit power level may be 0 dBm (except in pairing
mode) and the transmit power level in pairing mode may be -22 dBm. Since
the desired radio node address of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400,
500 may be not known by the remote control assembly 300 in pairing mode,
both infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 and remote control
assembly 300 may use a lower transmit power to reduce the likelihood of
inadvertently pairing with another infusion pump assembly.
[0831] AES Encryption may be used for all packets but may not be required,
as the Texas Instruments CC2510 radio transceiver includes this
functionality. If AES encryption is used, fixed keys may be utilized, as
fixed keys provide a quick way to enable encryption without passing keys.
However, key exchange may be provided for in future versions of infusion
pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500. The fixed keys may be contained in one
separate header source file with no other variables but the fixed keys
data, thus allowing for easier management of read access of the file.
[0832] The radio software may support the following eight modes: [0833]
Pairing Mode [0834] RF Off Mode [0835] Connection Mode [0836] Acquisition
Mode [0837] Fast Heartbeat Mode [0838] Slow Heartbeat Mode [0839] Search
Sync Mode [0840] Sync'ed Acquisition Mode
[0841] which are graphically depicted in FIGS. 120B-120C.
[0842] Pairing may be the process of exchanging radio serial numbers
between remote control assembly 300 and infusion pump assembly 100, 100',
400, 500. Remote control assembly 300 may be "paired" with infusion pump
assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 when infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400,
500 knows its serial number. Infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500
may be "paired" with remote control assembly 300 when remote control
assembly 300 knows its serial number.
[0843] Pairing mode (which is graphically depicted in FIG. 120D) may
require that four messages to be exchanged over the RF link: [0844] RF
Pairing Request (broadcast from Remote control assembly 300 to any
Infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500) [0845] RF Pairing Acknowledge
(from Infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 to Remote control
assembly 300) [0846] RF Pairing Confirm Request (from Remote control
assembly 300 to Infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500) [0847] RF
Pairing Confirm Acknowledge (from Infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400,
500 to Remote control assembly 300)
[0848] Additionally, remote control assembly 300 may cancel the pairing
process at any time via the RF pairing abort message (from remote control
assembly 300 to infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500. Pairing mode
may not support messaging system data transfers.
[0849] The radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may enter
pairing mode upon receiving a pairing mode request message. It may be the
responsibility of supervisor processor 1800 on infusion pump assembly
100, 100', 400, 500 to request the radio to enter pairing mode if there
is no disposable attached to infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500
and the user has pressed the button of infusion pump assembly 100, 100',
400, 500 for six seconds. The radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100',
400, 500 may set the appropriate transmit power level for pairing mode.
Infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may only be paired with one
remote control assembly 300 at a time.
[0850] Upon receiving the first valid RF pairing request message while in
pairing mode, the radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may
use the serial number of remote control assembly 300 for the duration of
pairing mode and respond with an RF pairing acknowledge message
containing the radio serial number infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400,
500.
[0851] The radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may timeout
of pairing mode automatically after 2.0.+-.0.2 seconds if no RF pairing
request is received. The radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400,
500 may issue a pairing request received message after transmitting the
RF pairing acknowledge. This message to supervisor processors will allow
feedback to the user during the pairing confirm process. The radio of
infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may automatically timeout of
pairing mode in 1.0.+-.0.1 minutes after sending an RF pairing
acknowledge unless an RF pairing confirm request is received. The radio
of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may issue a store paired
radio serial number message if an RF pairing confirm request message is
received after receiving a RF pairing request message. This action may
store the radio serial number of remote control assembly 300 in the
non-volatile memory of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 and may
overwrite the existing pairing data for the infusion pump assembly 100,
100', 400, 500.
[0852] The radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may
transmit an RF pairing confirm acknowledge and exit pairing mode after
the acknowledgment from the store paired radio serial number message is
received. This may be the normal exit of pairing mode on infusion pump
assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 and may result in infusion pump assembly
100, 100', 400, 500 powering down until connection mode or paring mode
entered by the user.
[0853] If the radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 exits
pairing mode upon successfully receiving a pairing confirm request
message, then the radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may
revert to the newly paired remote control assembly 300 and may send a
pairing completion success message to command processor 1802. The radio
of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may exit pairing mode upon
receiving an RF pairing abort message. The radio of infusion pump
assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may exit pairing mode upon receiving a
pairing abort request message addressed to it. This may allow command
processor 1802 or supervisor processor 1800 to abort the pairing process
locally on the infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500.
[0854] The radio of remote control assembly 300 may enter pairing mode
upon receiving a pairing mode request message. It may be the
responsibility of the UI processor of remote control assembly 300 to
request that the radio enter pairing mode under the appropriate
conditions. The radio of remote control assembly 300 may set the
appropriate transmit power level for pairing mode. The radio of remote
control assembly 300 may transmit RF pairing requests until an RF pairing
acknowledge is received or pairing is aborted.
[0855] The radio of remote control assembly 300 may automatically abort
pairing mode if the RF pairing acknowledge message is not received within
30.0.+-.1.0 seconds after entering pairing mode. Upon receiving the first
valid RF pairing acknowledge message while in pairing mode, the radio of
remote control assembly 300 may send a pairing success message to the UI
processor of remote control assembly 300 that includes the serial number
of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 and may use that serial
number for the duration of pairing mode. This message may provide a means
for the UI processor of remote control assembly 300 to have the user
confirm the serial number of the desired infusion pump assembly 100,
100', 400, 500. If the radio of remote control assembly 300 receives
multiple responses (concerning a single pairing request) from infusion
pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500, the first valid one may be used.
[0856] The Radio of remote control assembly 300 may only accept an RF
pairing confirm acknowledge messages after an RF pairing acknowledge is
received while in pairing mode. The radio of remote control assembly 300
may transmit the RF pairing confirm message upon receiving a pair confirm
request message from the UI processor of remote control assembly 300.
[0857] The radio of remote control assembly 300 may check that infusion
pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 confirms the pairing before adding
infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 to the pairing list. The radio
of remote control assembly 300 may issue a store paired radio serial
number message if an RF pairing complete message is received. This action
may allow the UI processor of remote control assembly 300 to store the
new serial number of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 and
provide user feedback of a successful pairing. It may be the
responsibility of the UI processor of remote control assembly 300 to
manage the list of paired infusion pump assemblies.
[0858] The radio of remote control assembly 300 may send an RF pairing
abort message and exit pairing mode upon receiving a pairing abort
request message. This may allow the UI processor of the remote control
assembly 300 to abort the pairing process on both the remote control
assembly 300 and acknowledged infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500.
[0859] In connection request mode, the radio of remote control assembly
300 may attempt to acquire each infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400,
500 in its paired infusion pump assembly list and retrieve its
"connection ready" status. The "connection" process (which is graphically
depicted in FIG. 120E) may allow remote control assembly 300 to quickly
identify one of its paired infusion pump assemblies that may be ready to
be used. The radio of remote control assembly 300 may be capable of
performing the connection request mode with up to six paired infusion
pump assemblies. Connection request mode may be only supported on remote
control assembly 300 and may be a special form of acquisition mode. In
connection request mode, remote control assembly 300 may connect with the
first infusion pump assembly to respond. However, each message may be
directed to a specific infusion pump assembly serial number.
[0860] The radio of remote control assembly 300 may obtain the latest
paired infusion pump assembly serial number list upon entering connection
mode. The radio of remote control assembly 300 may enter connection mode
upon receiving a connection mode request message. It may be the
responsibility of the UI processor of remote control assembly 300 to
request that the radio enter connection mode when it desires
communications with a paired infusion pump assembly. The radio of remote
control assembly 300 may issue a connection assessment message to the UI
processor of remote control assembly 300 containing the radio serial
number of the first infusion pump assembly, if any, that is "connection
ready". The radio of remote control assembly 300 may generate the
connection assessment message within thirty seconds of entering
connection request mode. The radio of remote control assembly 300 may
exit connection request mode upon receipt of the connection assessment
acknowledgement and transition to fast heartbeat mode. The radio of
remote control assembly 300 may exit connection request mode upon receipt
of a connection request abort message from the UI processor of remote
control assembly 300.
[0861] On remote control assembly 300, acquisition mode may be used to
find a particular paired infusion pump assembly. The radio of remote
control assembly 300 may send RF RUT (aRe yoU There) packets to the
desired paired infusion pump assembly. If the infusion pump assembly
receives the RF RUT message, it may respond to the radio of remote
control assembly 300. Multiple channels may be used in the acquisition
mode algorithm to improve the opportunity for the radio of remote control
assembly 300 to find the paired infusion pump assembly.
[0862] The radio of remote control assembly 300 may enter acquisition mode
upon receiving an acquisition mode request or fast heartbeat mode request
message while in RF Off Mode. The radio of remote control assembly 300
may enter sync'ed acquisition mode upon receiving an acquisition mode
request or fast heartbeat mode request message while in search sync mode.
It may be the responsibility of the UI processor of remote control
assembly 300 to request that the radio enter acquisition mode when the RF
link is off-line and remote control assembly 300 desires communications
with infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500.
[0863] The radio of remote control assembly 300 may only communicate with
one paired infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 (except in pairing
and connection modes). When communications are lost, the UI processor of
remote control assembly 300 may use acquisition mode (at some periodic
rate limited by the power budget) to attempt to restore communications.
[0864] Infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may enter acquisition
mode under the following conditions: [0865] When in Radio Off Mode and
Acquisition Mode may be requested [0866] When Search Sync Mode times out
due to lack of heartbeats
[0867] Upon entering acquisition mode, the radio of infusion pump assembly
100, 100', 400, 500 may obtain the serial number of the last stored
paired remote control assembly 300. The radio of infusion pump assembly
100, 100', 400, 500 may only communicate with the remote control assembly
to which it has been "paired" (except while in the "pairing request"
mode). The radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may
transition from acquisition mode to fast heartbeat mode upon successfully
acquiring synchronization with the remote control assembly 300. The
acquisition mode of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may be
capable of acquiring synchronization within 6.1 seconds, which may
implies that the infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may always be
listening at least every .about.6 seconds when in acquisition mode.
[0868] Data packets may be sent between two paired devices when the two
devices are in sync mode and online. The two devices may sync via a
heartbeat packet before data packets are exchanged. Each radio may send
data packets at known time intervals after the heartbeat exchange. The
infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may adjust its timing to
anticipate reception of a packet. The radio may support one data packet
in each direction on each heartbeat. The radio may provide a negative
response to a fast heartbeat mode request if the radio if offline. The
radio of remote control assembly 300 may change to fast heartbeat mode if
a system request for fast heartbeat mode is received while in slow
heartbeat mode and the radio is online.
[0869] Upon transitioning to fast heartbeat mode from acquisition mode,
the radio of remote control assembly 300 may send the master channel list
message. The master channel list may be built by the radio of remote
control assembly 300 and sent to the radio of infusion pump assembly 100,
100', 400, 500 to allow a selection of frequency hopping channels based
on historical performance. When in fast heartbeat mode or slow heartbeat
mode, periodic heartbeat messages may be exchanged between the radio of
remote control assembly 300 and the radio of infusion pump assembly 100,
100', 400, 500. The periodicity of these messages may be at the heartbeat
rate. The heartbeat messages may allow data packet transfers to take
place and may also exchange status information. The two radios may
exchange the following status information: Quiet Mode, data availability,
buffer availability, heartbeat rate, and prior channel performance. It
may be a goal to keep the packet size of the heartbeat messages small in
order to conserve power. The radio may provide for a maximum data packet
size of eighty-two bytes when in Sync Mode. The messaging system may be
designed to support packet payload sizes up to sixty-four bytes. This
maximum size was selected as an optimal trade-off between minimum
messages types and non-fragmented messages. The eighty-two bytes may be
the maximum packet size of the messaging system including packet
overhead.
[0870] The messaging system has an API that may allow the radio protocol
to send an incoming radio packet to it. The messaging system may also
have an API that allows the radio protocol to get a packet for
transmission over the radio network. The messaging system may be
responsible for packet routing between the radio protocol and the SPI
port. Data packets may be given to the messaging system for processing.
The messaging system may have an API that allows the radio protocol to
obtain a count of the number of data packets waiting to be sent over the
radio network. The radio protocol may query the messaging system on each
heartbeat to determine if data packets are available to send over the
radio network. It may be desirable for the software to check the
availability of a message just before the heartbeat is sent to minimize
round trip message latency.
[0871] The radio protocol may be capable of buffering one incoming radio
data packet and passing the packet to the messaging system. The radio
protocol may send the data packet to the messaging system upon receipt of
the data packet. The message system may be responsible for routing radio
data packets to the proper destination node. The radio protocol may be
capable of buffering one packet from the messaging system.
[0872] The radio protocol may be responsible for acknowledging receipt of
valid data packets over the RF link via an RF ACK reply packet to the
sending radio. The RF ACK packet may contain the source and destination
radio serial numbers, RF ACK command identification, and sequence number
of the data packet being acknowledged.
[0873] The radio transmitting a radio data packet may retransmit that
radio data packet on the next heartbeat with the same sequence number if
an RF ACK is not received and the retry count is within the maximum RF
retries allowed. It may be expected that, from time to time, interference
will corrupt a transmission on a particular frequency. An RF retry allows
the same packet to be retransmitted at the next opportunity at a
different frequency. The sequence number provides a means of uniquely
identifying the packet over a short time window. The number of radio
packet retries may be configurable using the radio configuration command.
Allowing more retries may increase the probability of a packet being
exchanged but introduces more latency for a round trip messages. The
default number of radio retries at power up may be ten (i.e., the maximum
transmission attempts before dropping the message).
[0874] A one byte (modulo 256) radio sequence number may be included in
all radio data packets over the RF link. Since the radio may be
responsible for retrying data packet transmission if not acknowledged,
the sequence number may provide a way for the two radios to know if a
data packet is a duplicate. The transmitted sequence number may be
incremented for each new radio data packet and may be allowed to
rollover. When a data packet is successfully received with the same
sequence number as the previous successfully received data packet (and in
the same direction), the data packet may be ACK'd and the received data
packet discarded. This may remove duplicate packets generated by the RF
protocol before they are introduced into the network. Note that it may be
possible that multiple data packets in a row may need to be dropped with
the same sequence number under extreme situations.
[0875] If a heartbeat is missed, the radio of remote control assembly 300
and the radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may attempt
to send and listen respectively for subsequent heartbeats. The radio of
remote control assembly 300 and the radio of infusion pump assembly 100,
100', 400, 500 may automatically change from fast heartbeat mode or slow
heartbeat mode to search sync mode if heartbeats are missed for two
seconds. This may minimize power consumption when the link is lost by
allowing the radios to continue to use their synchronization information,
as two seconds allows sufficient time to hop through all channels.
[0876] The radio may be considered online while in the following modes:
[0877] Fast Heartbeat mode [0878] Slow Heartbeat mode
[0879] as these are the only conditions where messaging system traffic may
be exchanged. All other conditions may be considered offline.
[0880] The radio may initialize to radio off mode at the start of code
execution from reset. When code first executes on the radio processor,
the initial state may be the radio off mode to allow other processors to
perform self-tests before requesting the radio to be active. This
requirement does not intend to define the mode when waking from sleep
mode. The radio may cease RF communications when set to radio off mode.
On remote control assembly 300, this mode may be intended for use on an
airplane to suppress RF emissions. Since infusion pump assembly 100,
100', 400, 500 only responds to transmissions from remote control
assembly 300 (which will have ceased transmitting in airplane mode),
radio off mode may only be used on infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400,
500 when charging.
[0881] Command processor 1802 may be informed of airplane mode and that,
therefore, the RF was intentionally turned off on remote control assembly
300 so that it does not generate walk-away alerts. However, this may be
completely hidden from the radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100',
400, 500.
[0882] The radio of remote control assembly 300 and the radio of infusion
pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may periodically attempt to exchange
heartbeats in order to reestablish data bandwidth while in search sync
mode. The radio of remote control assembly 300 may transition to radio
off mode after twenty minutes of search sync mode with no heartbeats
successfully exchanged.
[0883] The radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may
transition to acquisition mode after twenty minutes of search sync mode
with no heartbeats successfully exchanged.
[0884] Listening during pre-agreed time slots may be the most efficient
use of power for infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 to
re-establish the RF link. After a loss of communications, the crystal
tolerance and temperature drift may make it necessary to expand the
receive window of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 over time.
Staying in search sync mode for extended periods (e.g., 5-20 minutes)
after communications loss may cause the instantaneous power consumed to
exceed the average power budgeted for the radio of infusion pump assembly
100, 100', 400, 500. The radio of remote control assembly 300 may not be
forced to expand its window, so staying in search sync mode may be very
power efficient. Acquisition mode may consume more power for remote
control assembly 300. Twenty minutes may be used as a compromise to
balance power consumption on both the radio of remote control assembly
300 and the radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500.
[0885] The radio of remote control assembly 300 and the radio of infusion
pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may transition to slow heartbeat mode
if they successfully exchange three of the last five heartbeats.
Approximately every six seconds, a burst of five heartbeats may be
attempted. If three of these are successful, the bandwidth may be assumed
to be sufficient to transition to slow heartbeat mode. The radio of
infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may be acquirable while in
search sync mode with a latency of 6.1 seconds. This may imply that the
infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 may always be listening at
least every .about.6 seconds when in search sync mode.
[0886] Radio protocol performance statistics may be necessary to promote
troubleshooting of the radio and to assess radio performance. The
following radio performance statistics may be maintained by the radio
protocol in a data structure:
TABLE-US-00012
NAME SIZE DESCRIPTION
TX Heartbeat Count 32 Bits Total transmitted heartbeats
RX Heartbeat Count 32 bits Total valid received heartbeats
CRC Errors 16 bits Total packets received over the RF link which were
dropped due to bad CRC. This may be a subset of RX
Packets Nacked.
First Retry Count 32 bits Total number of packets which were successfully
acknowledged after 1 retry
Second Retry Count 32 bits Total number of packets which were successfully
acknowledged after 2 retries
Third Retry Count 32 bits Total number of packets which were successfully
acknowledged after 3 retries
Fourth Retry Count 32 bits Total number of packets which were successfully
acknowledged after 4 retries
Fifth Retry Count 16 bits Total number of packets which were successfully
acknowledged after 5 retries
Sixth Retry Count 16 bits Total number of packets which were successfully
acknowledged after 6 retries
Seventh Retry Count 16 bits Total number of packets which were
successfully
acknowledged after 7 retries
Eighth Retry Count 16 bits Total number of packets which were successfully
acknowledged after 8 retries
Ninth Retry Count 16 bits Total number of packets which were successfully
acknowledged after 9 retries
Tenth Retry Count 16 bits Total number of packets which were successfully
acknowledged after 10 retries
Dropped Retry Count 16 bits Total number of packets which were dropped
after
maximum retries attempts
Duplicate Packet Count 16 bits Total number of received packets dropped
due to duplicate
packet
1 to 5 Missed Fast Mode Hops 16 bits Count of 1 to 5 consecutive missed
hops in Fast mode (i.e.
not received)
6 to 16 Missed Fast Mode Hops 16 bits Count of 6 to 16 consecutive missed
hops in Fast mode.
17 to 33 Missed Fast Mode Hops 16 bits Count of 17 to 33 consecutive
missed hops in Fast mode
34+ Missed Fast Mode Hops 16 bits Count of 34 or more consecutive missed
hops in Fast mode
1 to 2 Missed Slow Mode Hops 16 bits Count of 1 to 2 consecutive missed
hops in Slow mode (i.e.
not received)
3 to 5 Missed Slow Mode Hops 16 bits Count of 3 to 5 consecutive missed
hops in Slow mode
5 to 7 Missed Slow Mode Hops 16 bits Count of 5 to 7 consecutive missed
hops in Slow mode
8+ Missed Slow Mode Hops 16 bits Count of 8 or more consecutive missed
hops in Slow mode
Destination Radio Serial Number 16 bits Count of received packets in which
the destination made it
Mismatch past the hardware filtering but does not match this radio's
serial number. This may be not an error but indicates that
the radio may be waking up and receiving (but not
processing) packets intended for other radios
Total Walkaway Time (minutes) 16 bits
Total Walkaway Events 16 bits Together with total walkaway time provides
an average
walkaway time
Number of Pairing Attempts 16 bits
Total Time in Acquisition Mode 16 bits
(Infusion pump assembly 100, 100',
400, 500 Only)
Total Acquisition Mode Attempts 16 bits Successful Acquisition Count 16
bits Count of transistions
(Remote control assembly 300 Only) from Connect or Acquisition Mode to
Fast Heartbeat Mode
Requested Slow Heartbeat Mode 16 bits
Transitions
Automatic Slow Heartbeat Mode 16 bits
Transitions
Radio offline messages sent 16 bits
Radio online messages sent 16 bits
[0887] A #define DEBUG option (compiler option) may be used to gather the
following additional radio performance statistics per each channel (16
bit numbers): [0888] Number of missed hops [0889] CCA good count [0890]
CCA bad count [0891] Average RSSI (accumulated for good RX packets only)
[0892] Dropped from Frequency Hop List count [0893] Acquisition Mode
count (found pair on this channel)
[0894] The debug option may be used to gather engineering only statistics.
If processor performance, power, and memory allow, it may be desirable to
keep this information at runtime. The radio statistics may be made
available to the messaging system.
[0895] Link quality may be intended to be used on remote control assembly
300 to provide a bar indicator, similar to a cell phone, of the radio
link quality. Link quality may be made available to both remote control
assembly 300 and infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500. It may be
anticipated that the link quality status will consist of a one byte
indicator of the quality of the radio link.
[0896] The radio may change frequency for each heartbeat. An adaptive
pseudo random frequency hopping algorithm may be used for sync mode and
heartbeat attempts in search sync mode. It may be a goal to use
sixty-four channels for frequency hopping. An algorithm may be developed
to adaptively generate a channel list on remote control assembly 300 for
frequency hopping. The radio of remote control assembly 300 may build,
maintain, and distribute the master channel list. Prior channel
statistics and historical performance information may be obtained from
the radio of infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 by the radio of
remote control assembly 300 using the messaging system as needed to meet
performance requirements. By building the channel list from the
perspective of both units, the radio interference environment of both
units may be considered. The radios may adaptively select hopping
channels to meet the round trip message latency, while operating in a
desirable RF environment.
[0897] Occlusions and/or leaks may occur anywhere along the fluid delivery
path of infusion pump assembly 100. For example and referring to FIG.
121, occlusions/leaks may occur: in the fluid path between reservoir 118
and reservoir valve assembly 614; in the fluid path between reservoir
valve assembly 614 and pump assembly 106; in the fluid path between pump
assembly 106 and volume sensor valve assembly 612; in the fluid path
between volume sensor valve assembly 612 and volume sensor chamber 620;
in the fluid path between volume sensor chamber 620 and measurement valve
assembly 610; and in the fluid path between measurement valve assembly
610 and the tip of disposable cannula 138. Infusion pump assembly 100 may
be configured to execute one or more occlusion/leak detection algorithms
that detect and locate such occlusions/leaks and enhance the
safety/reliability of infusion pump assembly 100.
[0898] As discussed above, when administering the infusible fluid,
infusion pump assembly 100 may first determine the volume of infusible
fluid within volume sensor chamber 620 prior to the administration of the
dose of infusible fluid and may subsequently determine the volume of
infusible fluid within volume sensor chamber 620 after the administration
of the dose of infusible fluid. By monitoring these values, the
occurrence of occlusions/leaks may be detected.
[0899] Occlusion Type--Total:
[0900] When a total occlusion is occurring, the difference between the
initial measurement prior to the administration of the dose of infusible
fluid and the final measurement after the administration of the dose of
infusible fluid will be zero (or essentially zero), indicating a large
residual quantity of infusible fluid within volume sensor chamber 620.
Accordingly, no fluid may be leaving volume sensor chamber 620.
[0901] Specifically, if the tip of disposable cannula is occluded, the
fluid path down stream of volume sensor chamber 620 will fill with fluid
and eventually become pressurized to a level equivalent to the mechanical
pressure exerted by spring diaphragm 628. Accordingly, upon measurement
valve assembly 610 opening, zero (or essentially zero) fluid will be
dispensed and, therefore, the value of the initial and final measurements
(as made by volume sensor assembly 148) will essentially be equal.
[0902] Upon detecting the occurrence of such a condition, a total
occlusion flag may be set and infusion pump assembly 100 may e.g.,
trigger an alarm, thus indicating that the user needs to seek alternative
means for receiving their therapy.
[0903] Occlusion Type--Partial:
[0904] When a partial occlusion is occurring, the difference between the
initial measurement prior to the administration of the dose of infusible
fluid and the final measurement after the administration of the dose of
infusible fluid will indicate that less than a complete dose of infusible
fluid was delivered. For example, assume that at the end of a particular
pumping cycle, volume sensor assembly 148 indicated that 0.10 microliters
of infusible fluid were present in volume sensor chamber 620. Further,
assume that measurement value assembly 610 is subsequently closed and
pump assembly 106 is subsequently actuated, resulting in volume sensor
chamber 620 being filed with the infusible fluid. Further assume that
volume sensor assembly 148 determines that volume sensor chamber 620 is
now filled with 1.00 microliters of infusible fluid (indicating a pumped
volume of 0.90 microliters).
[0905] Accordingly, upon the opening of measurement valve assembly 610,
the quantity of infusible fluid included within volume sensor chamber
would be expected to drop to 0.10 microliters (or reasonably close
thereto). However, in the event of a partial occlusion, due to a
slower-than-normal flow rate from volume sensor chamber 620, the quantity
of infusible fluid within volume sensor chamber 620 may only be reduced
to 0.40 microliters (indicating a delivered volume of 0.60 microliters).
Accordingly, by monitoring the difference between the pumped volume (0.90
microliters) and the delivered volume (0.60 microliters), the residual
volume may be defined and the occurrence of a partial occlusion may be
detected.
[0906] Upon detecting the occurrence of such a condition, a partial
occlusion flag may be set and infusion pump assembly 100 may e.g.,
trigger an alarm, thus indicating that the user needs to seek alternative
means for receiving their therapy. However, as this is indicative of a
partial occlusion (as opposed to a complete occlusion), the issuance of
an alarm may be delayed, as the partial occlusion may clear itself.
[0907] Alternatively, infusion pump assembly 100 may: calculate a pump
ontime to volume delivered ratio; track it through time; and track by
using a fast moving and a slow moving exponential average of the pump
ontime. The exponential average may be tracked, in a fashion similar to
the leaky sum integrator. The infusion pump assembly 100 may filter
signal and look for a fast change. The rate of fluid outflow and/or
residual volume may be monitored. If the residual volume does not change,
then there may be a total occlusion. If the residual volume changed, they
may be a partial occlusion. Alternatively still, the residual values may
be summed. If the number of valve actuations or the latch time is being
varied, the fluid flow rate may be examined, even if you build up
pressure in volume sensor assembly 148.
[0908] Total/Partial Empty Reservoir:
[0909] When reservoir 118 is becoming empty, it will become more difficult
to fill volume sensor chamber 620 to the desired level. Typically, pump
assembly 106 is capable of pumping 1.0 microliters per millisecond. For
example, assume that an "empty" condition for volume sensor chamber 620
is 0.10 microliters and a "full" condition for volume sensor chamber 620
is 1.00 microliters. However, as reservoir 118 begins to empty, it may
become harder for pump assembly 106 to fill volume sensor chamber 620 to
the "full" condition and may consistently miss the goal. Accordingly,
during normal operations, it may take one second for pump assembly 106 to
fill volume sensor chamber 620 to the "full" condition and, as reservoir
118 empties, it may take three seconds to fill volume sensor chamber 620
to the "full" condition. Eventually, if reservoir 118 completely empties,
volume sensor chamber 620 may never be able to achieve a "full
condition". Accordingly, the inability of pump assembly 106 to fill
volume sensor chamber 620 to a "full" condition may be indicative of
reservoir 118 being empty. Alternatively, the occurrence of such a
condition may be indicative of other situations (e.g., the failure of
pump assembly 106 or an occlusion in the fluid path prior to volume
sensor chamber 620). Infusion pump assembly 100 may determine the
difference between the "full" condition and the amount actually pumped.
These differences may be summed and the made up for once the reservoir
condition is addressed.
[0910] Upon detecting the occurrence of such a condition, an empty flag
may be set and infusion pump assembly 100 may e.g., trigger an alarm,
thus indicating that the user needs to e.g., replace disposable housing
assembly 114.
[0911] Additionally, as reservoir 118 empties, reservoir 118 will
eventually result in a "vacuum" condition and the ability of pump
assembly 106 to deliver fluid to volume sensor chamber 620 may be
compromised. As discussed above, volume controller 1602 may include feed
forward controller 1652 for setting an initial "guess" concerning
"on-time" signal 1606, wherein this initial guess is based upon a pump
calibration curve. For example, in order for pump assembly 106 to deliver
0.010 units of infusible fluid, feed forward controller 1652 may define
an initial "on-time" of e.g., one millisecond. However, as reservoir 118
begins to empty, due to compromised pumping conditions, it may take two
milliseconds to deliver 0.010 units of infusible fluid. Further, as
reservoir 118 approaches a fully empty condition, it make take ten
milliseconds to deliver 0.010 units of infusible fluid. Accordingly, the
occurrence of reservoir 118 approaching an empty condition may be
detected by monitoring the level at which the actual operation of pump
assembly 106 (e.g., two milliseconds to deliver 0.010 units of infusible
fluid) differs from the anticipated operation of pump assembly 106 (e.g.,
one millisecond to deliver 0.010 units of infusible fluid).
[0912] Upon detecting the occurrence of such a condition, a reserve flag
may be set and infusion pump assembly 100 may e.g., trigger an alarm,
thus indicating that the user will need to e.g., replace disposable
housing assembly 114 shortly.
[0913] Leak Detection:
[0914] In the event of a leak (e.g., a leaky valve or a
rupture/perforation) within the fluid path, the ability of the fluid path
to retain fluid pressure may be compromised. Accordingly, in order to
check for leaks within the fluid path, a bleed down test may be performed
in which pump assembly 106 is used to pressurize volume sensor chamber
620. Volume sensor assembly 148 may then perform a first volume
measurement (as described above) to determine the volume of infusible
fluid within volume sensor chamber 620. Infusion pump assembly 100 may
then wait a defined period of time to allow for bleed down in the event
of a leak. For example, after a sixty second bleed down period, volume
sensor assembly 148 may perform a second volume measurement (as described
above) to determine the volume of infusible fluid within volume sensor
chamber 620. If there are no leaks, the two volume measurements should be
essentially the same. However, in the event of a leak, the second
measurement may be less then the first measurement. Additionally,
depending on the severity of the leak, pump assembly 106 may be incapable
of filling volume sensor chamber 620. Typically, a leak check may be
performed as part of a delivery of infusible fluid.
[0915] In the event that the difference between the first volume
measurement and the second volume measurement exceeds an acceptable
threshold, a leak flag may be set and infusion pump assembly 100 may
e.g., trigger an alarm, thus indicating that the user needs to seek
alternative means for receiving their therapy.
[0916] As discussed above, infusion pump assembly 100 may include
supervisor processor 1800, command processor 1802, and radio processor
1818. Unfortunately, once assembled, access to electrical control
assembly 110 within infusion pump assembly 100 very limited. Accordingly,
the only means to access electrical control assembly 110 (e.g., for
upgrading flash memories) may be through the communication channel
established between infusion pump assembly 100, 100', 400, 500 and remote
control assembly 300, or via electrical contacts 834 used by battery
charger 1200.
[0917] Electrical contacts 834 may be directly coupled to radio processor
1818 and may be configured to provide I2C communication capability for
erasing/programming any flash memory (not shown) included within radio
processor 1818. The process of loading a program into radio processor
1818 may provide a means for erasing/programming of the flash memories in
both the supervisor processor 1800 and command processor 1802.
[0918] When programming supervisor processor 1800 or command processor
1802, the program (i.e., data) to be loaded into flash memory accessible
by supervisor processor 1800 or command processor 1802 may be provided in
a plurality of data blocks. This is because the radio processor 1818 may
not have enough memory to hold the entire flash image of the software as
one block.
[0919] Referring also to FIG. 122, there is shown one illustrative example
of the manner in which the various systems within infusion pump assembly
100, 100', 400, 500 may be interconnected. For example, battery charger
1200 may be coupled to computing device 2100 (e.g., a personal computer)
via bus translator 2102, which converts e.g., RS232 formatted data to
e.g., I2C formatted data. Bus translator 2102 may execute a pass-through
program that effectuates the above-described translation. Battery charger
1200 may be coupled to radio processor 181 via electrical contacts 834
(described above). Radio processor 1818 may then be coupled to supervisor
processor 1800 and command processor 1802 via e.g., an RS232 bus. Radio
processor 1818 may execute an update program that allows radio processor
1818 to control/orchestrate the updating of the flash memories accessible
by supervisor processor 1800 and command processor 1802. Accordingly,
through the use of the above-described coupling, software updates
obtained by computing device 2100 may be uploaded to flash memory (not
shown) accessible by supervisor processor 1800 and command processor
1802. The above-described software updates may be command line program
that may be automatically invoked by a script process.
[0920] As discussed above, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may
be configured to deliver an infusible fluid to a user. Further and as
discussed above, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may deliver
the infusible fluid via sequential, multi-part, infusion events (that may
include a plurality of discrete infusion events) and/or one-time infusion
events. However, in some embodiments, infusion pump assembly 100, 100'
400, 500 may deliver stacking bolus infusion events. For example, a user
may request the delivery of a bolus, e.g., 6 units. While the 6 units are
in the process of being delivered to the user, the user may request a
second bolus, e.g., 3 units. In some embodiments of infusion pump
assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may deliver the second bolus at the
completion of the first bolus.
[0921] Examples of other such sequential, multi-part, infusion events may
include but are not limited to a basal infusion event and an
extended-bolus infusion event. As is known in the art, a basal infusion
event refers to the repeated injection of small (e.g. 0.05 unit)
quantities of infusible fluid at a predefined interval (e.g. every three
minutes) that may be repeated until stopped, e.g., by a user or by the
system. Further, the basal infusion rates may be pre-programmed and may
include specified rates for pre-programmed time-frames, e.g., a rate of
0.50 units per hour from 6:00 am-3:00 pm; a rate of 0.40 units per hour
from 3:00 pm-10:00 pm; and a rate of 0.35 units per hour from 10:00
pm-6:00 am. However, the basal rate may be 0.025 units per hour, and may
not change according to pre-programmed time-frames. The basal rates may
be repeated regularly/daily until otherwise changed.
[0922] Further and as is known in the art, an extended-bolus infusion
event may refer to the repeated injection of small (e.g. 0.05 unit)
quantities of infusible fluid at a predefined interval (e.g. every three
minutes) that is repeated for a defined number of intervals (e.g., three
intervals) or for a defined period of time (e.g., nine minutes). An
extended-bolus infusion event may occur simultaneously with a basal
infusion event.
[0923] If multiple infusion events conflict with each other, infusion pump
assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may prioritize the infusion event in the
follow manner.
[0924] Referring also to FIG. 123, assume for illustrative purposes only
that the user configures infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 to
administer a basal dose (e.g. 0.05 units) of infusible fluid every three
minutes. The user may utilize remote control assembly 300 to define a
basal infusion event for the infusible fluid (e.g., 1.00 units per hour).
[0925] Infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may then determine an
infusion schedule based upon the basal infusion event defined. Once
determined, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may administer the
sequential, multi-part, infusion event (e.g., 0.05 units of infusible
fluid every three minutes). Accordingly, while administering the
sequential, multi-part, infusion event, infusion pump assembly 100, 100'
400, 500: may infuse a first 0.05 unit dose 2200 of the infusible fluid
at t=0:00 (i.e., a first discrete infusion event), may infuse a second
0.05 unit dose 2202 of the infusible fluid at t=3:00 (i.e., a second
discrete infusion event); may infuse a third 0.05 unit dose 2204 of the
infusible fluid at t=6:00 (i.e., a third discrete infusion event); may
infuse a fourth 0.05 unit dose 2206 of the infusible fluid at t=9:00
(i.e., a fourth discrete infusion event); and may infuse a fifth 0.05
unit dose 2208 of the infusible fluid at t=12:00 (i.e., a fifth discrete
infusion event). As discussed above, this pattern of infusing 0.05 unit
doses of the infusible fluid every three minutes may be repeated until
stopped, e.g., by a user or by the system, in this example, as this is an
illustrative example of a basal infusion event.
[0926] Further, assume for illustrative purposes that the infusible fluid
is insulin and sometime after the first 0.05 unit dose 2200 of infusible
fluid is administered (but before the second 0.05 unit dose 2202 of
infusible fluid is administered), the user checks their blood glucose
level and realizes that their blood glucose level is running a little
higher than normal. Accordingly, the user may define an extended bolus
infusion event via remote control assembly 300. An extended bolus
infusion event may refer to the continuous infusion of a defined quantity
of infusible fluid over a finite period of time. However, as such an
infusion methodology is impractical/undesirable for an infusion pump
assembly, when administered by such an infusion pump assembly, an
extended bolus infusion event may refer to the infusion of additional
small doses of infusible fluid over a finite period of time.
[0927] Accordingly, the user may utilize remote control assembly 300 to
define an extended bolus infusion event for the infusible fluid (e.g.,
0.20 units over the next six minutes), which may be confirmed in a manner
discussed above. While, in this example, the extended bolus infusion
event is described as 0.20 units over the next six minutes, this is for
illustrative purposes only and is not intended to be a limitation of this
disclosure, as either or both of the unit quantity and total time
interval may be adjusted upward or downward. Once defined and/or
confirmed, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may determine an
infusion schedule based upon the extended bolus infusion event defined;
and may administer the infusible fluid. For example, infusion pump
assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may deliver 0.10 units of infusible fluid
every three minutes for the next two interval cycles (or six minutes),
resulting in the delivery of the extended bolus dose of infusible fluid
defined by the user (i.e., 0.20 units over the next six minutes).
[0928] Accordingly, while administering the second, sequential,
multi-part, infusion event, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may
infuse a first 0.10 unit dose 2210 of the infusible fluid at t=3:00
(e.g., after administering the second 0.05 unit dose 2202 of infusible
fluid). Infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may also infuse a
second 0.10 unit dose 2212 of the infusible fluid at t=6:00 (e.g., after
administering the third 0.05 unit dose 2204 of infusible fluid).
[0929] Assume for illustrative purposes only that after the user programs
infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 via remote control assembly 300
to administer the first sequential, multi-part, infusion event (i.e.,
0.05 units infused every three minute interval repeated continuously) and
administer the second sequential, multi-part, infusion event (i.e., 0.10
units infused every three minute interval for two intervals), the user
decides to eat a very large meal. Predicting that their blood glucose
level might increase considerably, the user may program infusion pump
assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 (via remote control assembly 300) to
administer a one-time infusion event. An example of such a one-time
infusion event may include but is not limited to a normal bolus infusion
event. As is known in the art, a normal bolus infusion event refers to a
one-time infusion of the infusible fluid.
[0930] For illustrative purposes only, assume that the user wishes to have
infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 administer a bolus dose of
thirty-six units of the infusible fluid. Infusion pump assembly 100, 100'
400, 500 may monitor the various infusion events being administered to
determine whether a one-time infusion event is available to be
administered. If a one-time infusion event is available for
administration, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may delay the
administration of at least a portion of the sequential, multi-part,
infusion event.
[0931] Continuing with the above-stated example, once the user completes
the programming of infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 to deliver
one-time infusion event 2214 (i.e., the thirty-six unit bolus dose of the
infusible fluid), upon infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500
determining that the one-time infusion event is available for
administration, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may delay the
administration of each sequential, multi-part infusion event and
administer the available one-time infusion event.
[0932] Specifically and as discussed above, prior to the user programming
infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 to deliver one-time infusion
event 2214, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 was administering a
first sequential, multi-part, infusion event (i.e., 0.05 units infused
every three minute interval repeated continuously) and administering a
second sequential, multi-part, infusion event (i.e., 0.10 units infused
every three minute interval for two intervals).
[0933] For illustrative purposes only, the first sequential, multi-part,
infusion event may be represented within FIG. 123 as 0.05 unit dose 2200
@ t=0:00, 0.05 unit dose 2202 @ t=3:00, 0.05 unit dose 2204 @ t=6:00,
0.05 unit dose 2206 @ t=9:00, and 0.05 unit dose 2208 @ t=12:00. As the
first sequential, multi-part, infusion event as described above is a
basal infusion event, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may
continue to infuse 0.05 unit doses of the infusible fluid at three minute
intervals indefinitely (i.e., until the procedure is cancelled by the
user).
[0934] Further and for illustrative purposes only, the second sequential,
multi-part, infusion event may be represented within FIG. 123 as 0.10
unit dose 2210 @ t=3:00 and 0.10 unit dose 2212 @ t=6:00. As the second
sequential, multi-part, infusion event is described above as an extended
bolus infusion event, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may
continue to infuse 0.10 unit doses of the infusible fluid at three minute
intervals for exactly two intervals (i.e., the number of intervals
defined by the user).
[0935] Continuing with the above-stated example, upon infusion pump
assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 determining that the thirty-six unit normal
bolus dose of the infusible fluid (i.e., one-time infusion event 2214) is
available for administration, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500
may delay the administration of each sequential, multi-part infusion
event and may start administering one-time infusion event 2214 that is
available for administration.
[0936] Accordingly and for illustrative purposes only, assume that upon
completion of the programming of infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400,
500 to deliver the thirty-six unit normal bolus does of the infusible
fluid (i.e., the one-time infusion event), infusion pump assembly 100,
100' 400, 500 begins administering one-time infusion event 2214. Being
that one-time infusion event 2214 is comparatively large, it may take
longer than three minutes (i.e., the time interval between individual
infused doses of the sequential, multi-part, infusion events) and one or
more of the individual infused doses of the sequential, multi-part,
infusion events may need to be delayed.
[0937] Specifically, assume that it will take infusion pump assembly 100,
100' 400, 500 greater than six minutes to infuse thirty-six units of the
infusible fluid. Accordingly, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500
may delay 0.05 unit dose 2202 (i.e., scheduled to be infused @ t=3:00),
0.05 unit dose 2204 (i.e., scheduled to be infused @ t=6:00), and 0.05
unit dose 2206 (i.e., scheduled to be infused @ t=9:00) until after
one-time infusion event 2214 (i.e., the thirty-six unit normal bolus dose
of the infusible fluid) is completely administered. Further, infusion
pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may delay 0.10 unit dose 2210 (i.e.,
scheduled to be infused @ t=3:00 and 0.10 unit dose 2212 (i.e., scheduled
to be infused @ t=6:00) until after one-time infusion event 2214.
[0938] Once administration of one-time infusion event 2214 is completed by
infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500, any discrete infusion events
included within the sequential, multi-part, infusion event that were
delayed may be administered by infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500.
Accordingly, once one-time infusion event 2214 (i.e., the thirty-six unit
normal bolus dose of the infusible fluid) is completely administered,
infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may administer 0.05 unit dose
2202, 0.05 unit dose 2204, 0.05 unit dose 2206, 0.10 unit dose 2210, and
0.10 unit dose 2212.
[0939] While infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 is shown to
administer 0.05 unit dose 2202, then 0.10 unit dose 2210, then 0.05 unit
dose 2204, then 0.10 unit dose 2212, and then 0.05 unit dose 2206, this
is for illustrative purposes only and is not intended to be a limitation
of this disclosure, as other configurations are possible and are
considered to be within the scope of this disclosure. For example, upon
infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 completing the administration
of one-time infusion event 2214 (i.e., the thirty-six unit normal bolus
dose of the infusible fluid), infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500
may administer all of the delayed discrete infusion events associated
with the first sequential, multi-part infusion event (i.e., namely 0.05
unit dose 2202, 0.05 unit dose 2204, and 0.05 unit dose 2206). Infusion
pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may then administer all of the delayed
discrete infusion events associated with the second sequential,
multi-part infusion event (i.e., 0.10 unit dose 2210, and 0.10 unit dose
2212).
[0940] While one-time infusion event 2214 (i.e., the thirty-six unit
normal bolus dose of the infusible fluid) is shown as being infused
beginning at t=3:00, this is for illustrative purposes only and is not
intended to be a limitation of this disclosure. Specifically, infusion
pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may not need to begin infusing one-time
infusion event 2214 at one of the three-minute intervals (e.g., t=0:00,
t=3:00, t=6:00, t=9:00, or t=12:00) and may begin administering one-time
infusion event 2214 at any time.
[0941] While each discrete infusion event (e.g., 0.05 unit dose 2202, 0.05
unit dose 2204, 0.05 unit dose 2206, 0.10 unit dose 2210, and 0.10 unit
dose 2212) and one-time infusion event 2214 are shown as being a single
event, this is for illustrative purposes only and is not intended to be a
limitation of this disclosure. Specifically, at least one of the
plurality of discrete infusion events e.g., 0.05 unit dose 2202, 0.05
unit dose 2204, 0.05 unit dose 2206, 0.10 unit dose 2210, and 0.10 unit
dose 2212) may include a plurality of discrete infusion sub-events.
Further, one-time infusion event 2214 may include a plurality of one-time
infusion sub-events.
[0942] Referring also to FIG. 124 and for illustrative purposes, 0.05 unit
dose 2202 is shown to include ten discrete infusion sub-events (e.g.,
infusion sub-events 2216.sub.1-10), wherein a 0.005 unit dose of the
infusible fluid is infused during each of the ten discrete infusion
sub-events. Additionally, 0.10 unit dose 2210 is shown to include ten
discrete infusion sub-events (e.g., infusion sub-events 2218.sub.1-10),
wherein a 0.01 unit dose of the infusible fluid is delivered during each
of the ten discrete infusion sub-events. Further, one-time infusion event
2214 may include e.g., three-hundred-sixty one-time infusion sub-events
(not shown), wherein a 0.1 unit dose of the infusible fluid is delivered
during each of the three-hundred-sixty one-time infusion sub-events. The
number of sub-events defined above and the quantity of the infusible
fluid delivered during each sub-event is solely for illustrative purposes
only and is not intended to be a limitation of this disclosure, as the
number of sub-events and/or the quantity of the infusible fluid delivered
during each sub-event may be increased or decreased depending upon e.g.,
the design criteria of infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500.
[0943] Before, after, or in between the above-described infusion
sub-events, infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 may confirm the
proper operation of infusion pump assembly 100, 100' 400, 500 through the
use of any of the above-described safety features (e.g., occlusion
detection methodologies and/or failure detection methodologies).
[0944] In the exemplary embodiments, the infusion pump assembly may be
wirelessly controlled by a remote control device. In the exemplary
embodiments, a split ring resonator antenna may be used for wireless
communication between the infusion pump assembly and the remote control
device (or other remote device). The term "wirelessly controlled" refers
to any device that may receive input, instructions, data, or other,
wirelessly. Further, a wirelessly controlled insulin pump refers to any
insulin pump that may wirelessly transmit and/or receive data from
another device. Thus, for example, an insulin pump may both receive
instructions via direct input by a user and may receive instructions
wirelessly from a remote controller.
[0945] Referring to FIG. 127, an exemplary embodiment of a split ring
resonator antenna adapted for use in a wirelessly controlled medical
device, and is used in the exemplary embodiment of the infusion pump
assembly, includes at least one split ring resonator antenna (hereinafter
"SRR antenna") 2508, a wearable electric circuit, such as a wirelessly
controlled medical infusion apparatus (hereinafter "infusion apparatus")
2514, capable of powering the antenna, and a control unit 2522.
[0946] In various embodiments, a SRR antenna 2508 may reside on the
surface of a non-conducting substrate base 2500, allowing a metallic
layer (or layers) to resonate at a predetermined frequency. The substrate
base 2500 may be composed of standard printed circuit board material such
as Flame Retardant 2 (FR-2), FR-3, FR-4, FR-5, FR-6, G-10, CEM-1, CEM-2,
CEM-3, CEM-4, CEM-5, Polyimide, Teflon, ceramics, or flexible Mylar. The
metallic resonating bodies comprising a SRR antenna 2508 may be made of
two rectangular metallic layers 2502, 2504, made of, for example,
platinum, iridium, copper, nickel, stainless steel, silver or other
conducting materials. In other various embodiments, a SRR antenna 2508
may contain only one metallic resonating body.
[0947] In the exemplary embodiment, a gold-plated copper outer layer 2502,
surrounds, without physically contacting, a gold-plated copper inner ring
2504. That is, the inner ring 2504 resides in the cavity 2510 (or
aperture) formed by the outer layer 2502. The inner ring 2504 may contain
a gap, or split 2506, along its surface completely severing the material
to form an incomplete ring shape. Both metallic resonating bodies 2502,
2504 may reside on the same planar surface of the substrate base 2500. In
such a configuration, the outer layer 2502 may by driven via a
transmission line 2512 coupled to the outer layer 2502, for example.
Additionally, in various other embodiments, a transmission line 2512 may
be coupled to the inner ring 2504.
[0948] Antenna design software, such as AWR Microwave Office, capable of
simulating electromagnetic geometries, such as, antenna performance, may
significantly decrease the time required to produce satisfactory
dimensions compared to physically fabricating and testing antennas.
Accordingly, with aid of such software, the SRR antenna 2508 may be
designed such that the geometric dimensions of the resonant bodies 2502,
2504 facilitate an operational frequency of the 2.4 GHz ISM Band. FIG.
132 depicts the exemplary dimensions of the inner ring 2504 and outer
layer 2502, and the positioning of the cavity 2510 in which the inner
ring 2504 resides. The distance in between the outer layer 2502 and the
inner ring 2504 is a constant 0.005 inches along the perimeter of the
cavity 2510. However, in other embodiments, the distance between the
outer layer and the inner ring may vary and in some embodiments, the
operational frequency may vary.
[0949] In various embodiments, a SRR antenna 2508 may have dimensions such
that it could be categorized as electrically small, that is, the greatest
dimension of the antenna being far less than one wavelength at
operational frequency.
[0950] In various other embodiments, a SRR antenna 2508 may be composed of
one or more alternatively-shaped metallic outer layers, such as circular,
pentagonal, octagonal, or hexagonal, surrounding one or more metallic
inner layers of similar shape. Further, in various other embodiments, one
or more metallic layers of a SRR antenna 2508 may contain gaps in the
material, forming incomplete shapes.
[0951] Referring to FIG. 130, a SRR antenna 2508 having the exemplary
geometry exhibits acceptable return loss and frequency values when placed
in contact with human skin. As shown in FIG. 130, focusing on the band of
interest denoted by markers 1 and 2 on the graph, return loss prior to
contact with human skin is near -15 dB while monitoring a frequency band
centered around 2.44 GHz ISM Band. Return loss during contact with human
skin, as shown in FIG. 130A, remains a suitable value near -25 dB at the
same frequency, yielding approximately 97% transmission power.
[0952] These results are favorable especially as compared with a non-split
ring resonator antenna type, such as the Inverted-F. Return loss of an
Inverted-F antenna may exhibit a difference when the antenna contacts
human skin, resulting in a low percentage of power transmitted outward
from the antenna. By way of example, as shown in FIG. 133, and again
focusing on the band of interest denoted by markers 1 and 2 on the graph,
return loss of an Inverted-F antenna prior to contact with human skin is
near -25 dB at a frequency centered around 2.44 GHz. Return loss during
contact with human skin is nearly -2 dB at the same frequency, yielding
approximately 37% power transmission.
[0953] Integration with a Wireless Medical Device
[0954] In the exemplary embodiment, referring to FIG. 132 and FIG. 128,
one application of a SRR antenna 2508 may be integration into a wearable
infusion apparatus 2514 capable of delivering fluid medication to a
user/patient 2524. In such an application, the safety of the user/patient
is dependent on fluid operation between these electrical components, thus
reliable wireless transmission to and from a control unit 2522 is of
great importance.
[0955] An infusion apparatus 2514 may be worn directly on the human body.
By way of example, such a device may be attached on or above the hip
joint in direct contact with human skin, placing the SRR antenna 2508 at
risk of unintended dielectric loading causing a frequency shift in
electrical operation. However, in such an application, electrical
characteristics of the SRR antenna 2508 which allow it to be less
sensitive to nearby parasitic objects are beneficial in reducing or
eliminating degradation to the performance. A controlling component, such
as a control unit 2522 (generally shown in FIG. 131), may be paired with
an infusion apparatus 2514, and may be designed to transmit and receive
wireless signals to and from the infusion apparatus 2514 at a
predetermined frequency, which, in the exemplary embodiment, is the 2.4
GHz Industrial Scientific and Medical Band ("ISM band").. In the
exemplary embodiment, the control unit 2522 serves as the main user
interface through which a patient or third party may manage insulin
delivery. In other embodiments, infusion apparatus 2514 may utilize a SRR
antenna 2508 to communicate with one or more control units 2522.
[0956] In various embodiments, a number of different wireless
communication protocols may be used in conjunction with the SRR antenna
2508, as the protocol and data types to be transferred are independent of
the electrical characteristics of the antenna. However, in the exemplary
embodiment, a bi-directional master/slave means of communication
organizes the data transfer through the SRR antenna 2508. The control
unit 2522 may act as the master by periodically polling the infusion
apparatus 2514, or slave, for information. In the exemplary embodiment,
only when the slave is polled, the slave may send signals to the control
unit 2522 only when the slave is polled. However, in other embodiments,
the slave may send signals before being polled. Signals sent by way of
this system may include, but are not limited to, control, alarm, status,
patient treatment profile, treatment logs, channel selection and
negotiation, handshaking, encryption, and check-sum. In some embodiments,
transmission through the SRR antenna 2508 may also be halted during
certain infusion operations as an added precaution against electrical
disruption of administration of insulin to the patient.
[0957] In the exemplary embodiment, the SRR antenna 2508 may be coupled to
electrical source circuitry via one or more pins 2516 on a transmission
line 2512. In various other embodiments a transmission line may comprise
a wire, pairs of wire, or other controlled impedance methods providing a
signal path to the SRR antenna 2508. The transmission line 2512 may
reside on the surface of the substrate base 2500 and may be composed of
the same material as the SRR antenna 2508, such as gold-plated copper.
Additionally, a ground plane may be attached to the surface of the
substrate base opposite the transmission line 2512.
[0958] The electrical circuitry coupled to the SRR antenna 2508 may apply
an RF signal to the end of the transmission line 2512 nearest the
circuitry, creating an electromagnetic field throughout, and propagating
from, the SRR antenna 2508. The electrical circuitry coupled to the SRR
antenna 2508 facilitates resonance at a predetermined frequency, which,
in the exemplary embodiment, is the 2.4 GHz ISM band. Preferably,
transmission line 2512 and SRR antenna 2508 both have impedances of 50
Ohms to simplify circuit simulation and characterization. However, in
other various embodiments, the transmission line and split ring resonator
antenna may have other impedance values, or a different resonating
frequency.
[0959] Referring to FIG. 129, a signal processing component(s) 2518, such
as, a filter, amplifier, or switch, may be integrated into the
transmission line 2512, or at some point between the signal source
connection pins 2516 and the SRR antenna 2508. In the exemplary
embodiment, the signal processing component 2518 is a band-pass filter to
facilitate desired signal processing, such as, allowing only the
exemplary frequency to be transmitted to the antenna, and rejecting
frequencies outside that range. In the exemplary embodiment, a Combline
band-pass filter 2518 may be included in the transmission line 2512
between the antenna and the signal source. However in other embodiments,
any other signal processing device, for example, but not limited to,
filters, amplifiers, or any other signal processing devices known in the
art.
[0960] In various embodiments, a SRR antenna 2508 may be composed of
metallic bodies capable of resonating on a flexible or rigid substrate.
As shown in FIG. 128 and FIG. 129, the exemplary embodiment incorporates
a curved SRR antenna on a flexible Polyimide substrate 2520. Polyimide
may be the exemplary material because it tends to be more flexible than
alternative substrates. This configuration may allow for simplified
integration into circular-shaped devices (such as a wirelessly controlled
medical infusion apparatus 2514), devices with irregular-shaped external
housing, or devices in which saving space is paramount.
[0961] In various embodiments, both control unit 2522 and base unit 2514
may incorporate a split SRR antenna 2508. This configuration may prove
beneficial where the control unit is meant to be handheld, in close
proximity to human skin, or is likely to be in close proximity to a
varying number of materials with varying dielectric constants.
[0962] In various other embodiments, a SRR antenna 2508 may be integrated
into a human or animal limb replacement. As prosthetic limbs are becoming
more sophisticated the electrical systems developed to control and
simulate muscle movements require much more wiring and data transfer
among subsystems. Wireless data transfer within a prosthetic limb may
reduce weight through reduced physical wiring, conserve space, and allow
greater freedom of movement. However, common antennas in such a system
may be susceptible to dielectric loading. Similar to the previously
mentioned benefits of integrating a SRR antenna 2508 into a wirelessly
controlled medical infusion apparatus, a prosthetic limb, such as a
robotic arm, may also come into contact with human skin or other
dielectric materials and benefit from the reduction of electrical
disturbances associated with such an antenna. In other various
embodiments, the SRR antenna 2508 may be integrated into any device
comprised of the electrical components capable of powering and
transmitting/receiving data to an antenna and susceptible to electrical
disturbances associated with proximity to dielectric materials.
[0963] In various embodiments, a SRR antenna 2508 may be integrated into a
configuration of medical components in which one or more implantable
medical devices, operating within the human body, communicate wirelessly
to a handheld, body-mounted, or remote control unit. In certain
embodiments, both body-mounted and in-body wireless devices may utilize a
SRR antenna 2508 for wireless communication. Additionally, one or more of
the components utilizing a SRR antenna 2508 may be completely surrounded
by human skin, tissue or other dielectric material. By way of example,
such a configuration may be used in conjunction with a heart
monitoring/control system where stability and consistency of wireless
data transmission are of fundamental concern.
[0964] In various other embodiments, a SRR antenna 2508 may be integrated
into the embodiments of the infusion pump assembly. In some embodiments,
the SRR antenna 2508 may be integrated into a configuration of medical
components in which one or more electrical sensors positioned on, or
attached to, the human body wirelessly communicate to a remote
transceiving unit. By way of example, a plurality of electrodes
positioned on the body may be coupled to a wireless unit employing a SRR
antenna 2508 for wireless transmission to a remotely located
electrocardiogram machine. By way of further example, a wireless
temperature sensor in contact with human skin may employ SRR antenna 2508
for wireless communication to a controller unit for temperature
regulation of the room in which the sensor resides.
System for Verification of Volume and Pumping
[0965] Infusion pump therapy includes volume and time specifications. The
amount of fluid dispensed together with the dispense timing are two
critical factors of infusion pump therapy. As discussed in detail below,
the infusion pump apparatus and systems shown and described herein
provide for a method of dispensing fluid together with a device, system
and method for measuring the amount of fluid dispensed. However, in a
circumstance where the calibration and precision of the measurement
device calibration is critical, there are advantages to determining any
compromise in the precision of the measurement device as soon as
possible. Thus, there are advantages to off-board verification of volume
and pumping.
[0966] As shown in the figures, the disposable assembly includes a
reservoir for holding the infusible fluid for pumping. There are various
methods and devices for filling the reservoir with infusible fluid, many
embodiments are discussed above. An additional embodiment and system for
both verifying the volume of fluid filled in the reservoir and verifying
the integrity of the pumping system is discussed below.
[0967] In one embodiment, a weight scale is used to determine the volume
of fluid filled into the disposable and may also be used for verification
by comparing the before-use volume with the after-use volume of the
disposable. In some embodiments, this is accomplished by weighing the
disposable before and after reservoir filling is complete. In some
embodiments, the weight scale may be reset to zero) (i.e., tared) to the
disposable prior to filling. In other embodiments, a weight may be taken
before the fill and afterwards. In some embodiments, a processor may
calculate the weight of the fluid filled and correlate the weight to a
volume of fluid. In some embodiments, the display on the scale may
automatically display the volume of fluid that has been filled in the
reservoir. The method of filling may be any discussed above, or an
automatic fill, as discussed below. In addition, in some embodiment, a
pre-filled reservoir may be used and thus, filling is not necessary,
rather, the weight would be taken prior to loading the reservoir and
after reservoir loading.
[0968] An exact calculation of the volume of fluid in a reservoir may be
used to verify the measurement system of the pumping device. For example,
following the use of the disposable, where the system either stores, or,
receives via an input the before-use weight at fill of the disposable,
the system, taking the after-use weight, may determine the volume of
fluid difference between before-use and after-use. This information may
be used as a check to the pumping system to verify the amount of fluid
pumped from the given reservoir.
[0969] Additionally, the exact volume of fluid filled may be entered into
the pumping system which may be used by the system to warn the user of
low-volume reservoir or present to the user an accurate volume of fluid
remaining in the reservoir at any given time.
[0970] Referring now to FIG. 205, one embodiment of the system includes a
combination charger, disposable fill and integrity verification station
2900. The charger station 2900 includes a charging section 2902 for a
reusable assembly, a charging section 2904 for a remote control device,
and a weight scale 2906. The weight scale 2906 in some embodiments may be
sized to accommodate a disposable assembly 2908. In the exemplary
embodiment, the station also includes a fill adapter septum 2910 that
accepts a filling cap 2912 (including a filling needle for piercing the
septum 2910). In some embodiments, the filling needle is attached to a
fluid line 2914 which may be a flexible tubing of a predetermined length
suitable for reaching around the station 2900 to, in some embodiments, a
fluid vial or fluid container holder 2916. The container holder 2916 may
be sized to accommodate a fluid vial 2918. In addition to the features
shown in FIG. 205, in some embodiments, the station 2900 may include a
pump for pumping the fluid from the container 2918 into the disposable
assembly 2908. In some embodiments, the pump may be a peristaltic pump.
However, in other embodiments, the pump may be a diaphragm pump or any of
pump known in the art. The pump may be used to automatically fill the
reservoir in the disposable 2908. In some embodiment, a user attaches the
container cap 2920 (including a needle) to the fluid container 2918 as
well as the filling cap 2912 to the fill adapter septum 2910. The pump
evacuates air from the disposable and uses it to pressurize the vial. The
pump then pulls fluid from the container 2918 and fills the disposable
2908 reservoir. Also, whilst filling the reservoir, the system may
provide enough positive pressure to additionally prime the fluid path and
the cannula of the disposable.
[0971] In some embodiments, the station 2900 may also include a display
for communication to a user of the volume of fluid currently in the
disposable 2908. This may be used to fill the reservoir to a desired
volume. Additionally, in some embodiments, the station 2900 may
wirelessly communicate to a remote controller (not shown) or other
device, the volume of fluid filled into the reservoir. In some
embodiments, when a user is finished with a disposable, the user will
weight the after-use disposable. The system will communicate with the
pumping system and correlating the data, an integrity verification test
may be performed. Where a system integrity error is determined, the
system may alarm the user appropriately.
[0972] In other embodiments, a station may include a weight scale and any
one or more of the various other components of the station 2900 as
discussed above. Still referring to FIG. 205, the system may be portable
and the scale portion 2922 may slide into the charger portion 2924,
protecting the integrity of the scale as well as providing convenient
portability.
[0973] Thus, this system has many benefits, including, but not limited to,
off-board integrity verification of volume sensing at each disposable
change; accurate determination of volume at fill to both accurately track
current reservoir volume and thus alarm user when volume is low; method
for avoiding under-desired-volume filling or over-desired-volume filling;
method of filling a disposable with fluid while also pre-priming (or
purging the air) the disposable fluid line; and verification of volume
regardless of disposable manufacture variability.
[0974] While the principles of the invention have been described herein,
it is to be understood by those skilled in the art that this description
is made only by way of example and not as a limitation as to the scope of
the invention. Other embodiments are contemplated within the scope of the
present invention in addition to the exemplary embodiments shown and
described herein. Modifications and substitutions by one of ordinary
skill in the art are considered to be within the scope of the present
invention.
* * * * *